GR 1600 Eu

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 285

WORKSHOP MANUAL

GR1600EU

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


TO THE READER
This Workshop Manual tells the servicing personnel about the mechanism, servicing and
maintenance of the GR1600EU, GR1600F and GR1600ID. It contains 4 parts: "Information",
"General", "Mechanism" and "Servicing".

 Information
This section primarily contains information below.
• Safety First
• Safety Decal
• Specification
• Dimension

 General
This section primarily contains information below.
• Engine Identification
• Model Identification
• General Precautions
• Maintenance Check List
• Check and Maintenance
• Special Tools

 Mechanism
This section contains information on the structure and the function of the unit. Before you continue
with the subsequent sections, make sure that you read this section.

 Servicing
This section primarily contains information below.
• Troubleshooting
• Servicing Specifications
• Tightening Torques
• Checking, Disassembling and Servicing

All illustrations, photographs and specifications contained in this manual are of the newest
information available at the time of publication.
KUBOTA reserves the right to change all information at any time without notice.
Since this manual includes many models, information or illustrations and photographs can show
more than one model.

June, 2011
© KUBOTA Corporation 2011

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


Record of Revisions
For pdf, use search function {Search word} to find the all revised locations.
Last digit
Issue Reference
of the Main Revised Point and Corrective Measures {Search word}
month Page
Code No.
2 2013.03 GR1600ID and RCK42-GR16 models are added. I-9,
{GR1600ID}, {RCK42-GR16} G-1,
G-9
and others
3 2013.11 Error characters of recommended inflation max. tire pressure are G-20
corrected.

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


I INFORMATION

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


INFORMATION

CONTENTS

1. SAFETY FIRST .............................................................................................................................. I-1


2. SAFETY DECALS .......................................................................................................................... I-4
3. SPECIFICATIONS.......................................................................................................................... I-9
4. DIMENSIONS ............................................................................................................................... I-10
[1] GR1600EU, GR1600F............................................................................................................ I-10
[2] GR1600ID............................................................................................................................... I-11

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM INFORMATION

1. SAFETY FIRST
SAFETY FIRST
• This symbol, the industry's "Safety Alert Symbol", is used throughout this manual and on labels on the
machine itself to warn of the possibility of personal injury. Read these instructions carefully.
• It is essential that you read the instructions and safety regulations before you try to repair or use this
unit.

DANGER
• Indicates an imminently hazardous situation which, if not avoided, will result in death or serious injury.

WARNING
• Indicates a potentially hazardous situation which, if not avoided, could result in death or serious injury.

CAUTION
• Indicates a potentially hazardous situation which, if not avoided, may result in minor or moderate
injury.

IMPORTANT
• Indicates that equipment or property damage could result if instructions are not followed.

NOTE
• Gives helpful information.
WSM000001INI0001US1
BEFORE YOU START SERVICE
• Read all instructions and safety instructions in this
manual and on your machine safety decals.
• Clean the work area and machine.
• Park the machine on a stable and level ground, and
set the parking brake.
• Lower the implement to the ground.
• Stop the engine, then remove the key.
• Disconnect the battery negative cable.
• Hang a "DO NOT OPERATE" tag in the operator
station.
WSM000001INI0010US0

START SAFELY
• Do not do the procedures below when you start the
engine.
– short across starter terminals
– bypass the safety start switch
• Do not alter or remove any part of machine safety
system.
• Before you start the engine, make sure that all shift
levers are in neutral positions or in disengaged
positions.
• Do not start the engine when you stay on the ground.
Start the engine only from operator's seat.
WSM000001INI0015US0

I-1

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM INFORMATION
OPERATE SAFELY
• Do not use the machine after you consume alcohol
or medication or when you are tired.
• Put on applicable clothing and safety equipment.
• Use applicable tools only. Do not use alternative
tools or parts.
• When 2 or more persons do servicing, make sure
that you do it safely.
• Do not operate below the machine that only a jack
holds. Always use a safety stand to hold the
machine.
• Do not touch the hot parts or parts that turn when the
engine operates.
• Do not remove the radiator cap when the engine
operates, or immediately after it stops. If not, hot
water can spout out from the radiator. Only remove
the radiator cap when it is at a sufficiently low
temperature to touch with bare hands. Slowly loosen
the cap to release the pressure before you remove it
fully.
• Released fluid (fuel or hydraulic oil) under pressure
can cause damage to the skin and cause serious
injury. Release the pressure before you disconnect
hydraulic or fuel lines. Tighten all connections before
you apply the pressure.
• Do not open a fuel system under high pressure.
The fluid under high pressure that stays in fuel lines
can cause serious injury. Do not disconnect or repair
the fuel lines, sensors, or any other components
between the fuel pump and injectors on engines with
a common rail fuel system under high pressure.
• Put on an applicable ear protective device (earmuffs
or earplugs) to prevent injury against loud noises.
• Be careful about electric shock. The engine
generates a high voltage of more than DC100 V in
the ECU and is applied to the injector.
WSM000001INI0012US0

PREVENT A FIRE
• Fuel is very flammable and explosive under some
conditions. Do not smoke or let flames or sparks in
your work area.
• To prevent sparks from an accidental short circuit,
always disconnect the battery negative cable first
and connect it last.
• The battery gas can cause an explosion. Keep the
sparks and open flame away from the top of battery,
especially when you charge the battery.
• Make sure that you do not spill fuel on the engine.
WSM000001INI0005US0

I-2

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM INFORMATION
KEEP A GOOD AIRFLOW IN THE WORK AREA
• If the engine is in operation, make sure that the area
has good airflow. Do not operate the engine in a
closed area. The exhaust gas contains poisonous
carbon monoxide.
WSM000001INI0006US0

DISCARD FLUIDS CORRECTLY


• Do not discard fluids on the ground, down the drain,
into a stream, pond, or lake. Obey related
environmental protection regulations when you
discard oil, fuel, coolant, electrolyte and other
dangerous waste.
WSM000001INI0007US0

PREVENT ACID BURNS


• Keep electrolyte away from your eyes, hands and
clothing. Sulfuric acid in battery electrolyte is
poisonous and it can burn your skin and clothing and
cause blindness. If you spill electrolyte on yourself,
clean yourself with water, and get medical aid
immediately.
WSM000001INI0008US0

PREPARE FOR EMERGENCIES


• Keep a first aid kit and fire extinguisher ready at all
times.
• Keep the emergency contact telephone numbers
near your telephone at all times.
WSM000001INI0009US0

I-3

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM INFORMATION

2. SAFETY DECALS
The following safety decals (pictorial safety labels) are installed on the machine. If a decal becomes
damaged, illegible or is not on the machine, replace it. The decal part number is listed in the parts list.
WSM000001INI0014US0

9Y1210595INI0001US0

I-4

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM INFORMATION

9Y1210595INI0002US0

I-5

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM INFORMATION

9Y1210595INI0003US0

I-6

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM INFORMATION

9Y1210595INI0007US0

I-7

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM INFORMATION
CARE OF PICTORIAL SAFETY LABELS
1. Keep pictorial safety labels clean and free from obstructing material.
2. Clean pictorial safety labels with soap and water, dry with a soft cloth.
3. Replace damaged or missing pictorial safety labels with new labels from your local KUBOTA Dealer.
4. If a component with pictorial safety label(s) affixed is replaced with new part, make sure new label(s) is (are)
attached in the same location(s) as the replaced component.
5. Put new pictorial safety labels by applying on a clean dry surface and pressing any bubbles to outside edge.
9Y1210595INI0006US0

I-8

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM INFORMATION

3. SPECIFICATIONS
Model GR1600EU GR1600F GR1600ID
Model Z482-E3-GX
Type Liquid-cooled diesel
Total displacement 479 cm3 (29.2 cu.in.)
Engine gross power (DIN) 10.0 kW (13.6 HP) *1
No. of cylinders 2
Engine Starter Electric starter with battery
Battery 51R (12 V, 475CCA)
Diesel fuel No.1 [below −10 °C (14 °F)]
Fuel
Diesel fuel No.2 [above −10 °C 14 °F)]
Preheating system Super glow
Engine stop Key stop
Fuel tank 18 L (4.8 U.S.gals, 4.0 lmp.gals)
Engine oil 1.2 L (1.3 U.S.qts, 1.11 lmp.qts)
Capacities
Radiator coolant 2.35 L (2.48 U.S.gals, 2.07 lmp.gals)
Hydrostatic transmission oil 2.8 L (0.74 U.S.gals, 0.62 lmp.gals)
Overall length
2710 mm (106.7 in.) 1920 mm (53.74 in.)
(with Grass Catcher)
Overall width
1110 mm (43.70 in.) 1365 mm (75.59 in.)
(with mower deck)
Dimensions
Overall height 1210 mm (47.64 in.)
Wheel base 1280 mm (50.39 in.)
Front 750 mm (29.5 in.)
Tread
Rear 820 mm (32.3 in.) 825 mm (32.4 in.)
Weight 420 kg (683 lbs) 370 kg (815 lbs)
Front 15 × 6.00 - 6 PR
Tires
Rear 20 × 10.00 - 8 PR
Steering Manual (Sector gear type)
Transmission Hydrostatic transmission
Traveling
Brake Internal expanding brake
system
Speed control Foot pedal
Differential Bevel gear
Traveling Forward 0 to 10.0 km/h (0 to 6.2 mph)
speed Reverse 0 to 5.0 km/h (0 to 3 mph)
PTO Shaft drive
PTO system Clutch Mechanical wet multi discs
PTO brake Wet multi discs

Model RCK42GREU RCK42GRF RCK42-GR16


Cutting width 1067 mm (40.21 in.)
Cutting height 25.0 to 102 mm (0.985 to 4.01 in.)
Adjustment of cutting height Dial gauge
Mounting method Quick joint, Parallel linkage
Weight (Approx.) 75 kg (170 lbs) 65 kg (144 lbs)
Mower Total length 965 mm (38.0 in.) 750 mm (29.6 in.)
Dimensions Total width 1110 mm (43.70 in.) 1365 mm (75.59 in.)
Total height 295 mm (11.6 in.) 280 mm (11.0 in.)
Discharge direction Rear
0.35 L
Gear box oil 0.33 L (0.35 U.S.qts, 0.29 Imp.qts)
(0.37 U.S.qts, 0.31 lmp.qts)

Model GCK370GREU –
Container capacity 370 L (97.7 U.S.gals, 81.4 Imp.gals) –
Grass catcher
Weight (Approx.) 15 kg (331 lbs) –
NOTE
• *Manufacture's estimate
The company reserves the right to change the specifications without notice.
9Y1210595INI0008US0

I-9

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM INFORMATION

4. DIMENSIONS
[1] GR1600EU, GR1600F

9Y1210595INI0005US0

I-10

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM INFORMATION

[2] GR1600ID

9Y1210595INI0009US0

I-11

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


G GENERAL

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GENERAL

CONTENTS

1. IDENTIFICATION ......................................................................................................................... G-1


[1] MODEL NAME AND SERIAL NUMBERS .............................................................................. G-1
[2] CYLINDER NUMBER ............................................................................................................. G-2
2. GENERAL PRECAUTIONS.......................................................................................................... G-3
3. HANDLING PRECAUTIONS FOR ELECTRICAL PARTS AND WIRING .................................... G-4
[1] WIRING .................................................................................................................................. G-4
[2] BATTERY ............................................................................................................................... G-6
[3] FUSE ...................................................................................................................................... G-6
[4] CONNECTOR ........................................................................................................................ G-6
[5] HANDLING OF CIRCUIT TESTER ........................................................................................ G-7
[6] COLOR OF WIRING .............................................................................................................. G-8
4. LUBRICANTS, FUEL AND COOLANT......................................................................................... G-9
5. TIGHTENING TORQUES........................................................................................................... G-12
[1] GENERAL USE SCREWS, BOLTS AND NUTS .................................................................. G-12
[2] STUD BOLTS ....................................................................................................................... G-12
[3] HYDRAULIC FITTINGS ....................................................................................................... G-13
(1) Hydraulic Hose Fittings................................................................................................... G-13
(2) Hydraulic Pipe Cap Nuts ................................................................................................ G-13
(3) Adaptors, Elbows and Others......................................................................................... G-13
[4] METRIC SCREWS, BOLTS AND NUTS .............................................................................. G-14
[5] AMERICAN STANDARD SCREWS, BOLTS AND NUTS WITH UNC OR UNF
THREADS ............................................................................................................................ G-14
[6] PLUGS ................................................................................................................................. G-14
6. MAINTENANCE CHECK LIST ................................................................................................... G-15
7. CHECK AND MAINTENANCE ................................................................................................... G-17
[1] DAILY CHECK...................................................................................................................... G-17
[2] CHECK POINTS OF EVERY 50 HOURS ............................................................................ G-23
[3] CHECK POINTS OF EVERY 100 HOURS .......................................................................... G-32
[4] CHECK POINT OF EVERY 150 HOURS ............................................................................. G-35
[5] CHECK POINTS OF EVERY 200 HOURS .......................................................................... G-35
[6] CHECK POINTS OF EVERY 400 HOURS .......................................................................... G-39
[7] CHECK POINT OF EVERY 1500 HOURS ........................................................................... G-40
[8] CHECK POINT OF EVERY 3000 HOURS ........................................................................... G-40
[9] CHECK POINTS OF EVERY 1 YEAR.................................................................................. G-41
[10]CHECK POINTS OF EVERY 2 YEARS ............................................................................... G-44
[11]SERVICE AS REQUIRED .................................................................................................... G-45
[12]MOWER ............................................................................................................................... G-46
(1) RCK42GREU, RCK42GRF ............................................................................................ G-46
(2) RCK42-GR16 ................................................................................................................. G-48
8. SPECIAL TOOLS ....................................................................................................................... G-50
[1] SPECIAL TOOLS FOR ENGINE .......................................................................................... G-50
[2] SPECIAL TOOLS FOR MACHINE ....................................................................................... G-56
9. TIRES ......................................................................................................................................... G-60
[1] TIRE PRESSURE................................................................................................................. G-60
[2] TREAD ................................................................................................................................. G-60
10. IMPLEMENT LIMITATIONS ....................................................................................................... G-61

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL

1. IDENTIFICATION
[1] MODEL NAME AND SERIAL NUMBERS
When contacting your local KUBOTA distributor, always specify
engine serial number (2), machine serial number (1), mower serial
number (3) and hour meter reading.
(1) Machine Serial Number [A] RCK42GR
(2) Engine Serial Number [B] RCK42-GR16
(3) Mower Serial Number
(4) Hour Meter
9Y1210595GEG0002US0

G-1

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL

[2] CYLINDER NUMBER


The cylinder numbers of KUBOTA diesel engine are designated
as shown in the figure.
The sequence of cylinder number is given as No. 1, No. 2 and
No. 3 starting from the front cover side.
9Y1210595GEG0052US0

G-2

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL

2. GENERAL PRECAUTIONS
• When you disassemble, carefully put the parts in a clean area
to make it easy to find the parts. You must install the screws,
bolts and nuts in their initial position to prevent the reassembly
errors.
• When it is necessary to use special tools, use KUBOTA special
tools. Refer to the drawings when you make special tools that
you do not use frequently.
• Before you disassemble or repair machine, make sure that you
always disconnect the ground cable from the battery first.
• Remove oil and dirt from parts before you measure.
• Use only KUBOTA genuine parts for replacement to keep the
machine performance and to make sure of safety.
• You must replace the gaskets and O-rings when you assemble
again. Apply grease (1) to new O-rings or oil seals before you
assemble.
• When you assemble the external or internal snap rings, make
sure that the sharp edge (3) faces against the direction from
which force (2) is applied.
• When inserting spring pins, their splits must face the direction
from which a force is applied. See the figure left side.
• To prevent damage to the hydraulic system, use only specified
fluid or equivalent.
• Clean the parts before you measure them.
• Tighten the fittings to the specified torque. Too much torque can
cause damage to the hydraulic units or the fittings. Not sufficient
torque can cause oil leakage.
• When you use a new hose or pipe, tighten the nuts to the
specified torque. Then loosen (approx. by 45 °) and let them be
stable before you tighten to the specified torque (This is not
applied to the parts with seal tape).
• When you remove the two ends of a pipe, remove the lower end
first.
• Use two pliers in removal and installation. One to hold the stable
side, and the other to turn the side you remove to prevent twists.
• Make sure that the sleeves of flared connectors and tapers of
hoses are free of dust and scratches.
• After you tighten the fittings, clean the joint and apply the
maximum operation pressure 2 to 3 times to examine oil
leakage.
(1) Grease (A) External Circlip
(2) Force (B) Internal Circlip
(3) Sharp Edge
(4) Axial Force
(5) Rotating Movement
WSM000001GEG0106US0

G-3

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL

3. HANDLING PRECAUTIONS FOR ELECTRICAL


PARTS AND WIRING
To ensure safety and prevent damage to the machine and
surrounding equipment, obey the following precautions in handling
electrical parts and wiring.
IMPORTANT
• Check electrical wiring for damage and loosened
connection every year. To this end, educate the customer
to do his or her own check and at the same time
recommend the dealer to perform periodic check for a fee.
• Do not try to modify or remodel any electrical parts and
wiring.
• When removing the battery cables, disconnect the negative
cable first. When installing the battery cables, connect the
positive cable first.
(1) Negative Terminal (2) Positive Terminal
WSM000001GEG0062US0

[1] WIRING
• Securely tighten wiring terminals.
(1) Correct (2) Incorrect
(Securely Tighten) (Loosening Leads to Faulty Contact)
WSM000001GEG0063US0

• Do not let wiring contact dangerous part.


(1) Dangerous Part (Sharp Edge) (3) Wiring (Correct)
(2) Wiring (Incorrect) (4) Dangerous Part
WSM000001GEG0064US0

• Repair or change torn or aged wiring immediately.


(1) Aged (3) Insulating Vinyl Tape
(2) Torn
WSM000001GEG0065US0

G-4

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL
• Securely insert grommet.
(1) Grommet (A) Correct
(B) Incorrect
WSM000001GEG0066US0

• Securely clamp, being careful not to damage wiring.


(1) Clamp (3) Clamp
(Wind Clamp Spirally) (4) Welding Dent
(2) Wire Harness
WSM000001GEG0067US0

• Clamp wiring so that there is no twist, unnecessary sag, or


excessive tension, except for movable part, where sag be
required.
(1) Wiring (A) Correct
(2) Clamp (B) Incorrect
WSM000001GEG0068US0

• In installing a part, be careful not to get wiring caught by it.


(1) Wiring (A) Incorrect
WSM000001GEG0069US0

• After installing wiring, check protection of terminals and


clamped condition of wiring.
(1) Cover
(Securely Install Cover)
WSM000001GEG0070US0

G-5

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL

[2] BATTERY
• Be careful not to confuse positive and negative terminal posts.
• When you remove battery cables, disconnect negative cable
first. When you install battery cables, check for polarity and
connect positive cable first.
• Do not install any battery with capacity other than is specified
(Ah).
• After you connect cables to battery terminal posts, apply high
temperature grease to them and securely install terminal covers
on them.
• Do not allow dirt and dust to collect on battery.

CAUTION
• Be careful not to let battery liquid spill on your skin and
clothes. If contaminated, wash it off with water
immediately.
• Before you recharge the battery, remove it from the
machine.
• Before you recharge, remove cell caps.
• Recharge in a well-ventilated place where there is no open
flame nearby, as hydrogen gas and oxygen are formed.
WSM000001GEG0071US0

[3] FUSE
• Use fuses with specified capacity.
Neither too large nor small capacity fuse is acceptable.
• Never use steel nor copper wire in place of fuse.
• Do not install working light, radio set, etc. on machine which is
not provided with reserve power supply.
• Do not install accessories if fuse capacity of reserve power
supply is exceeded.
(1) Fuse (3) Slow Blow Fuse
(2) Fusible Link
WSM000001GEG0072US0

[4] CONNECTOR
• For connector with lock, push lock to separate.
(A) Push
WSM000001GEG0073US0

• In separating connectors, do not pull wire harnesses.


• Hold connector bodies to separate.
(A) Correct (B) Incorrect
WSM000001GEG0074US0

G-6

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL
• Use sandpaper to remove rust from terminals.
• Repair deformed terminal. Make sure that there is no terminal
being exposed or displaced.
(1) Exposed Terminal (3) Sandpaper
(2) Deformed Terminal (4) Rust
WSM000001GEG0075US0

• Make sure that there is no female connector being too open.


(A) Correct (B) Incorrect
WSM000001GEG0076US0

• Make sure that plastic cover is large enough to cover whole


connector.
(1) Cover (A) Correct
(B) Incorrect
WSM000001GEG0077US0

[5] HANDLING OF CIRCUIT TESTER


• Use tester correctly following manual provided with tester.
• Check for polarity and range.
WSM000001GEG0078US0

G-7

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL

[6] COLOR OF WIRING


• Colors of wire are specified to the color codes.
• This symbol of "/" shows color with stripe(s).
(An example)
Red stripe on white color: W/R
Color of wiring Color code
Black B
Brown Br
Green G
Gray Gy or Gr
Blue L
Light Green Lg
Orange Or
Pink P
Purple Pu or V
Red R
Sky Blue Sb
White W
Yellow Y

(1) Wire Color (2) Stripe


WSM000001GEG0079US0

G-8

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL

4. LUBRICANTS, FUEL AND COOLANT


Capacity
No. Place Lubricants, fuel and coolant
GR1600EU GR1600F GR1600ID
• No. 2-D diesel fuel
18 L
• No. 1-D diesel fuel if
1 Fuel tank 4.8 U.S.gals
temperature is below –10 °C
4.0 lmp.gals
(14 °F)
Cooling 2.35 L
Fresh clean water with
2 system with 2.48 U.S.qts
anti-freeze
recovery tank 2.07 lmp.qts
Engine oil
API Service Classification CF or
higher
1.2 L • Above 25 °C (77 °F): SAE30,
Engine
3 1.3 U.S.qts SAE10W-30 or 15W-40
crankcase
1.1 lmp.qts • 0 to 25 °C (32 to 77 °F):
SAE20, 10W-30 or 15W-40
• Below 0 °C (32 °F): SAE10W,
SAE10W-30 or 15W-40
2.8 L
Transmission KUBOTA UDT or SUPER UDT
4 0.74 U.S.gals
case fluid*
0.62 lmp.gals
0.33 L 0.35 L
Mower gear SAE90 gear oil (API service
5 0.35 U.S.qts 0.37 U.S.qts
box classification: more than GL-3)
0.29 lmp.qts 0.31 lmp.qts

Greasing
No. of greasing point
No. Place Capacity Type of grease
GR1600EU GR1600F GR1600ID
Engine Multi-purpose
6 transmission 1 Until grease EP2 grease
universal joint overflows (NLGL Grade
7 King pin 2 No.2)
Speed control pedal
8 4
shaft
9 PTO lever 1
10 Mower lift lever 1
11 Seat adjuster 2
Around the hole of
12 2
the mower link Moderate
Engine oil
Around the pin of amount
13 2
the mower link
14 Pivot of mower link 2
15 Pivot of lift arm 2
16 Front link 2
17 Link fulcrum 2
18 Throttle cable 2

G-9

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL

Greasing
No. of greasing point
No. Place Capacity Type of grease
GR1600EU GR1600F GR1600ID
[Grass catcher]
19 Top cover look lever 2 –
20 Frame shaft 2 –
21 Top cover 2 – Moderate
Engine oil
22 Arm bracket 1 – amount

Rear quick clean


23 4 –
lever
[Mower]
Mower universal Multi-purpose
24 1
joint Until grease EP2 grease
25 Spindle shafts 2 – overflows (NLGL Grade
26 Belt tension pivot 1 No. 2)

NOTE
• Oil amount when the oil level is at the upper level of the oil level gauge.
• KUBOTA original transmission hydraulic fluid.
IMPORTANT
• To prevent serious damage to hydraulic systems, use only KUBOTA genuine fluid or its equivalent.
9Y1210595GEG0054US0

G-10

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL

NOTE
Engine Oil:
• Oil used in the engine should have an American Petroleum Institute (API) service classification and
Proper SAE Engine Oil according to the ambient temperatures as shown above:
• With the emission control now in effect, the CF-4 and CG-4 lubricating oils have been developed for use
of a low-sulfur fuel on on-road vehicle engines. When an off-road vehicle engine runs on a high-sulfur
fuel, it is advisable to employ the "CF or better" lubricating oil with a high Total Base Number (TBN of
10 minimum).
• Refer to the following table for the suitable API classification engine oil according to the engine type (with
internal EGR, external EGR or non-EGR) and the fuel (low-sulfur or high-sulfur fuel).
Engine oil classification (API classification)
Fuel used
Oil class of engines except external EGR Oil class of engines with external EGR
CF
(If the "CF-4, CG-4, CH-4 or CI-4"
High Sulfur Fuel
lubricating oil is used with a high-sulfur —
[≥ 0.05 % (500 ppm)]
fuel, change the lubricating oil at shorter
intervals. (approximately half))
Low Sulfur Fuel
[< 0.05 % (500 ppm)] CF or CI-4
or Ultra Low Sulfur CF, CF-4, CG-4, CH-4 or CI-4 (Class CF-4, CG-4 and CH-4 engine oils
Fuel cannot be used on EGR type engines)
[< 0.0015 % (15 ppm)]
EGR: Exhaust Gas Re-circulation
• The CJ-4 engine oil is intended for DPF (Diesel Particulate Filter) type engines, and cannot be used on this
machine.
except external EGR with external EGR
Models GR1600EU, GR1600F, GR1600ID —
Fuel:
• Cetane number of 45 minimum. Cetane number greater than 50 is preferred, especially for temperatures below
−20 °C or elevations above 1500 m.
• If diesel fuel with sulfur content greater than 0.5 % (5000 ppm) sulfur content is used, reduce the service interval
for engine oil and filter by 50 %.
• NEVER use diesel fuel with sulfur content greater than 0.05 % (500 ppm) for EXTERNAL EGR type engine.
• DO NOT use diesel fuel with sulfur content greater than 1.0 % (10000 ppm).
• Diesel fuels specified to EN 590 or ASTM D975 are recommended.
• No.2-D is a distillate fuel of lower volatility for engines in industrial and heavy mobile service. (SAE J313 JUN87)
Transmission Oil:
*KUBOTA Super UDT-2: For an enhanced ownership experience, we highly recommend Super UDT-2 to be used
instead of standard hydraulic/transmission fluid.
Super UDT-2 is a proprietary KUBOTA formulation that deliveries superior performance and protection in all
operating conditions.
Regular UDT is also permitted for use in this machine.
• Indicated capacities of water and oil are manufacturer's estimate.
9Y1210595GEG0055US0

G-11

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL

5. TIGHTENING TORQUES
[1] GENERAL USE SCREWS, BOLTS AND NUTS
Tighten screws, bolts and nuts whose tightening torques are not specified in this Workshop Manual
according to the table below.

Indication on top of bolt No-grade or 4T 7T 9T

Indication on top of nut No-grade or 4T


6T
Material of opponent part Ordinariness Aluminum Ordinariness Aluminum Ordinariness
Unit N·m kgf·m lbf·ft N·m kgf·m lbf·ft N·m kgf·m lbf·ft N·m kgf·m lbf·ft N·m kgf·m lbf·ft
7.9 0.80 5.8 7.9 0.80 5.8 9.81 1.00 7.24 7.9 0.80 5.8 12.3 1.25 9.05
M6 to to to to to to to to to to to to to to to
9.3 0.95 6.8 8.8 0.90 6.5 11.2 1.15 8.31 8.8 0.90 6.5 14.2 1.45 10.4
18 1.8 13 17 1.7 13 24 2.4 18 18 1.8 13 30 3.0 22
M8 to to to to to to to to to to to to to to to
20 2.1 15 19 2.0 14 27 2.8 20 20 2.1 15 34 3.5 25
40 4.0 29 32 3.2 24 48 4.9 36 40 4.0 29 61 6.2 45
M10 to to to to to to to to to to to to to to to
45 4.6 33 34 3.5 25 55 5.7 41 44 4.5 32 70 7.2 52
63 6.4 47 78 7.9 58 63 6.4 47 103 10.5 76.0
M12 to to to – – – to to to to to to to to to
72 7.4 53 90 9.2 66 72 7.4 53 117 12.0 86.7
108 11.0 79.6 124 12.6 91.2 167 17.0 123
M14 to to to – – – to to to – – – to to to
125 12.8 92.5 147 15.0 108 196 20.0 144
167 17.0 123 197 20.0 145 260 26.5 192
M16 to to to – – – to to to – – – to to to
191 19.5 141 225 23.0 166 304 31.0 224
246 25.0 181 275 28.0 203 344 35.0 254
M18 to to to – – – to to to – – – to to to
284 29.0 209 318 32.5 235 402 41.0 296
334 34.0 246 368 37.5 272 491 50.0 362
M20 to to to – – – to to to – – – to to to
392 40.0 289 431 44.0 318 568 58.0 419
WSM000001GEG0001US0

[2] STUD BOLTS


Material of opponent part Ordinariness Aluminum
Unit N·m kgf·m lbf·ft N·m kgf·m lbf·ft
12 1.2 8.7 8.9 0.90 6.5
M8 to to to to to to
15 1.6 11 11 1.2 8.6
25 2.5 18 20 2.0 15
M10 to to to to to to
31 3.2 23 25 2.6 18
30 3.0 22
M12 to to to 31 3.2 23
49 5.0 36
62 6.3 46
M14 to to to – – –
73 7.5 54
98.1 10.0 72.4
M16 to to to – – –
112 11.5 83.1
172 17.5 127
M18 to to to – – –
201 20.5 148
WSM000001GEG0002US0

G-12

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL

[3] HYDRAULIC FITTINGS


(1) Hydraulic Hose Fittings
Tightening torque
Hose size Thread side
N·m kgf·m lbf·ft
02 1/8 13.8 to 15.6 1.40 to 1.60 10.2 to 11.5
03
1/4 22.6 to 27.4 2.30 to 2.80 16.7 to 20.2
04
05
3/8 45.2 to 52.9 4.60 to 5.40 33.3 to 39.0
06
WSM000001GEG0097US0

(2) Hydraulic Pipe Cap Nuts


Tightening torque
Pipe size
N·m kgf·m lbf·ft
ϕ4 × t1.0 19.7 to 29.4 2.00 to 3.00 14.5 to 21.6
ϕ6 × t1.0 24.6 to 34.3 2.50 to 3.50 18.1 to 25.3
ϕ8 × t1.0 29.5 to 39.2 3.00 to 4.00 21.7 to 28.9
ϕ10 × t1.0 39.3 to 49.0 4.00 to 5.00 29.0 to 36.1
ϕ12 × t1.5 49.1 to 68.6 5.00 to 7.00 36.2 to 50.6
ϕ15 × t1.6 108 to 117 11.0 to 12.0 79.6 to 86.7
ϕ18 × t1.6 108 to 117 11.0 to 12.0 79.6 to 86.7
WSM000001GEG0098US0

(3) Adaptors, Elbows and Others


Tightening torque
Item Thread side
N·m kgf·m lbf·ft
G 1/8 45 to 53 4.5 to 5.5 33 to 39
G 1/4 74 to 83 7.5 to 8.5 55 to 61
Fitting with O-ring
G 3/8 93.2 to 102 9.50 to 10.5 68.8 to 75.9
G 1/2 113 to 122 11.5 to 12.5 83.2 to 90.4
G 1/8 23 to 26 2.3 to 2.7 17 to 19
G 1/4 36 to 43 3.6 to 4.4 26 to 31
Elbow with O-ring
G 3/8 54 to 63 5.5 to 6.5 40 to 47
G 1/2 73 to 83 7.4 to 8.5 54 to 61
G 1/8 9.8 to 14 1.0 to 1.5 7.3 to 10
G 1/4 30 to 34 3.0 to 3.5 22 to 25
Adapter
G 3/8 49 to 68 5.0 to 7.0 37 to 50
G 1/2 69 to 88 7.0 to 9.0 51 to 65
WSM000001GEG0099US0

G-13

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL

[4] METRIC SCREWS, BOLTS AND NUTS


Grade Property class 8.8 Property class 10.9
Unit N·m kgf·m lbf·ft N·m kgf·m lbf·ft
M8 24 to 27 2.4 to 2.8 18 to 20 30 to 34 3.0 to 3.5 22 to 25
M10 48 to 55 4.9 to 5.7 36 to 41 61 to 70 6.2 to 7.2 45 to 52
M12 78 to 90 7.9 to 9.2 58 to 66 103 to 117 10.5 to 12.0 76.0 to 86.7
M14 124 to 147 12.6 to 15.0 91.2 to 108 167 to 196 17.0 to 20.0 123 to 144
M16 197 to 225 20.0 to 23.0 145 to 166 260 to 304 26.5 to 31.0 192 to 224

WSM000001GEG0003US0

[5] AMERICAN STANDARD SCREWS, BOLTS AND NUTS WITH


UNC OR UNF THREADS
Grade SAE GR.5 SAE GR.8
Unit N·m kgf·m lbf·ft N·m kgf·m lbf·ft
1/4 11.7 to 15.7 1.20 to 1.60 8.63 to 11.5 16.3 to 19.7 1.67 to 2.00 12.0 to 14.6
5/16 23.1 to 27.7 2.36 to 2.82 17.0 to 20.5 33 to 39 3.4 to 3.9 25 to 28
3/8 48 to 56 4.9 to 5.7 36 to 41 61 to 73 6.3 to 7.4 45 to 53
1/2 110 to 130 11.3 to 13.2 81.2 to 95.8 150 to 178 15.3 to 18.1 111 to 131
9/16 150 to 178 15.3 to 18.1 111 to 131 217 to 260 22.2 to 26.5 160 to 191
5/8 204 to 244 20.8 to 24.8 151 to 179 299 to 357 30.5 to 36.4 221 to 263

WSM000001GEG0008US0

[6] PLUGS
Material of opponent part
Shape Size Ordinariness Aluminum
N·m kgf·m lbf·ft N·m kgf·m lbf·ft
R1/8 13 to 21 1.3 to 2.2 9.4 to 15 13 to 19 1.3 to 2.0 9.4 to 14
Tapered screw
R1/4 25 to 44 2.5 to 4.5 18 to 32 25 to 34 2.5 to 3.5 18 to 25
R3/8 49 to 88 5.0 to 9.0 37 to 65 49 to 58 5.0 to 6.0 37 to 43
R1/2 58.9 to 107 6.00 to 11.0 43.4 to 79.5 59 to 78 6.0 to 8.0 44 to 57
Straight screw G1/4 25 to 34 2.5 to 3.5 18 to 25 – – –
G3/8 62 to 82 6.3 to 8.4 46 to 60 – – –

G1/2 49 to 88 5.0 to 9.0 37 to 65 – – –

WSM000001GEG0005US0

G-14

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL

6. MAINTENANCE CHECK LIST


The following servicing tasks should be carried out on the machine at the stated running-time intervals.
Indication on hour meter Refer-
After
No. Item ence
50 100 150 200 250 300 350 400 450 500 550 600 since
page
every
1 Engine oil Change     G-36
200 Hr
every
2 Engine oil filter Replace     G-35
200 Hr
every
3 Transmission fluid Change  G-39
400 Hr
every
4 Transmission oil filter Replace     G-35
200 Hr
every
5 Transmission strainer Clean  G-40
400 Hr
every
6 Front axle pivot Adjust     G-38
200 Hr
every
7 Engine start system Check             G-24
50 Hr
every
8 OPC system Check             G-24
50 Hr
every
9 Oiling –             G-27
50 Hr
every
10 Greasing –             G-26
50 Hr
every
Check             G-26
50 Hr
11 Mower gear box oil
every
Change      G-35
150 Hr
every
Clean             G-25
50 Hr
12 Air cleaner element
every
Replace G-41
1 year
every
13 Battery condition Check             G-29
50 Hr
every
14 Brake Adjust       G-33
100 Hr
every
15 Fan drive belt Check       G-34
100 Hr
every
Check       G-32
100 Hr
16 Fuel filter element
every
Replace  G-40
400 Hr
every
Check       G-32
100 Hr
17 Fuel line
every
Replace G-44
2 years
every
Check    G-37
200 Hr
18 Radiator hose and clamp
every
Replace G-44
2 years
every
Check    G-38
200 Hr
19 Intake air line
every
Replace G-44
2 years
Fuel injection nozzle every
20 Check G-40
Injection pressure 1500 Hr
every
21 Injection pump Check G-40
3000 Hr
every
22 Radiator Clean G-41
1 year
every
23 Coolant Change G-41
1 year

G-15

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL

Indication on hour meter Refer-


After
No. Item ence
50 100 150 200 250 300 350 400 450 500 550 600 since
page
every
24 Mower gear box oil seal Replace G-44
2 years
every
25 Engine breather hose Replace G-44
2 years
26 Fuel system Bleed G-45
27 Fuse Replace Service G-45
as G-46,
28 Blade Replace required G-48
29 Mower belt Replace G-47

IMPORTANT
• The jobs indicated by  must be done initially.
• *1: This maintenance should be done daily more often in dusty conditions than in normal conditions.
Suggested cleaning interval is every 100 hours in normal conditions.
*2: These items should be serviced by an authorized KUBOTA Dealer, unless the owner has the proper
tools and is mechanically proficient.
*3: Consult your local KUBOTA Dealer for this service.
*4: Replace only if necessary
9Y1210595GEG0056US0

G-16

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL

7. CHECK AND MAINTENANCE


CAUTION
• Be sure to check and service the machine on a flat place with engine shut off, the parking brake on and
chock the wheels.
9Y1210595GEG0004US0

[1] DAILY CHECK


To prevent trouble from occurring, it is important to know the condition of the machine. Check the following items
before starting.
Checking
• Check areas where previous trouble was experienced.
• Walk around the machine.
1. Tire pressure, wear and damage
2. Oil and water leak
3. Engine oil level
4. Transmission fluid level
5. Coolant level in the recovery tank
6. Damage of machine body, tightness of all bolts and nuts
7. Radiator screen
8. Panel screen
9. Brake play
10. Air cleaner primary element
11. Fuel level
12. Oiling
• Mower
1. Oil leak
2. Make sure blade cap screws are tight.
3. Blades for wear or damage.
4. Check all hardware.
5. Make sure all pins are in place.
6. Mower deck cleaning
7. Greasing
• While sitting in the operator's seat.
1. Speed control pedal and brake pedal
2. Parking brake
3. Other movable parts
• Turning the key switch "ON"
1. Performance of the Easy Checker™ light.
• Starting the engine
1. Color of the exhaust fumes
2. Safety start switch, seat safety control and another safety control and another safety devices.
3. Check for abnormal noise and vibration.
• Others
1. Check the areas where previous troubles were experienced.
9Y1210595GEG0005US0

G-17

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL
Checking Engine Oil Level

CAUTION
To avoid personal injury:
• Always stop the engine and remove the key before
checking oil.
1. Check engine oil before starting and 5 minutes or more after the
engine has stopped.
2. Wipe dipstick (2) area clean.
3. To check the oil level, remove the dipstick (2), wipe it clean,
reinsert it, and draw it out again. Check to see that the oil level
is between the two notches.
4. Add new oil to the prescribed level at the oil inlet (1) if
necessary.
5. When using a different brand or viscosity oil from the previous
one, remove all of the old oil and oil filter. Never mix two different
types of oil.
6. Use the proper Engine Oil SAE according to the ambient
temperatures. (Refer to "4. LUBRICANTS, FUEL AND
COOLANT" on page G-9.)
(1) Engine Oil Inlet A: Upper Level
(2) Oil Level Dipstick B: Lower Level
9Y1210595GEG0006US0
Checking Amount of Fuel and Refueling

WARNING
To avoid serious injury:
• Handle fuel carefully. If the engine is running, do not fill the
fuel tank. If engine is hot, let engine cool several minutes
before adding fuel.
Do not smoke while filling the fuel tank or servicing the fuel
system. Fill fuel tank only to bottom of filler neck.
Check the fuel level. Take care that the fuel tank does not
become empty.
18 L
Fuel tank Capacity 4.8 U.S.gals
4.0 Imp.gals

IMPORTANT
• Use Diesel fuel only
1. Use No.2-D diesel fuel.
2. Use No.1-D diesel fuel if the temperature is below –10 °C
(14 °F).
3. Always use a strainer when refueling to prevent fuel
injection pump contamination.
• Do not permit dirt or trash or water to get into the fuel
system.
• Be careful not to let the fuel tank become empty, otherwise
air will enter the fuel system, necessitating bleeding before
next engine start.
• Be careful not to spill fuel during refueling. If a spill should
occur, wipe it off at once, or it may cause a fire.
• To prevent condensation (water accumulation) in the fuel
tank, fill the tank before parking overnight.
(1) Fuel Cap
9Y1210595GEG0007US0

G-18

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL
Checking Cleaning Radiator to Prevent Overheating

WARNING
To avoid serious injury or death:
• Engine components can get extremely hot from operation.
To prevent severe burns, do not touch these areas while
the engine is running, or immediately after it is turned off.
Never operate the engine without heat shields or guards.

CAUTION
To avoid personal injury:
• Be sure to stop the engine and remove the key before
cleaning.
NOTE
• The air intake area must be clear of debris to prevent the
engine from overheating.
• When assembling the panel screen (1), be sure to fit it to
panel with no clearance at the bottom.
Daily or after every 5 hours of operation, check to be sure the
radiator screen (2) and radiator core are clean. Dirt or chaff on the
radiator screen (2) or radiator core decrease cooling performance.
1. Remove the radiator screen (2) and panel screen (1) and
remove all foreign material.
2. Remove the dust from between the fins and the tube.
3. Tighten the fan drive belt as necessary. For this, refer to "[3]
CHECK POINTS OF EVERY 100 HOURS" on page G-32.
4. If scale forms in the tube, clean with the scale inhibitor or its
equivalent.
5. Each time the panel screen (1) is covered with grass during
operation, rub it off the screen with hand. Check the radiator
screen (2) from time to time if grass accumulates.
6. If the dust or chaff has accumulated inside of the panel, remove
the radiator screen (2) and clean inside completely. After
cleaning, reinstall the radiator screen (2) properly.
(1) Panel Screen (2) Radiator Screen
9Y1210595GEG0008US0

G-19

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL
Checking Tire Pressure

WARNING
To avoid serious injury or death:
• Do not attempt to mount a tire on a rim. This should be
done by a qualified person with the proper equipment.
• Always maintain the correct tire pressure.
Do not inflate tires above the recommended pressure.
• Inflation pressure in front tires rises quickly when using
compressed air.

CAUTION
To avoid personal injury:
• Never operate machine with a loose rim, wheel or axle.
• Whenever bolts are loosened, retighten to specified torque.
• Check all bolts frequently and keep them tightened.
 Inflation Pressure
Though the inflation pressure is factory-set to the prescribed
level, it naturally drops slowly in the course of time. Thus, check it
every day and inflate as necessary.
Recommended Inflation
Tire sizes
Max. Pressure
100 kPa
Front 15 × 6.00-6, 4PR
(1.02 kgf/cm2, 14.5 psi)
70 kPa
Rear 20 × 10.00-8, 4PR
(0.71 kgf/cm2, 10 psi)

(1) Ground (A) Insufficient


(B) Normal
(C) Excessive
9Y1210595GEG0009US0
Checking Transmission Fluid Level
1. Park the machine on a flat surface, lower the implement to the
ground and shut off engine and remove the key.
2. Raise the operator's seat.
3. To check the oil level, draw out the dipstick (1), wipe it clean,
reinsert it, and draw it out again. Check to see that the oil level
lies between the two notches. If the level is too low, add new oil
to the prescribed level at the oil inlet. (Refer to "4.
LUBRICANTS, FUEL AND COOLANT" on page G-9.)
IMPORTANT
• If oil level is low, do not run engine.
(1) Oil Level Dipstick A: Oil level is acceptable within this
range.
9Y1210595GEG0010US0

G-20

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL
Checking Coolant Level

CAUTION
To avoid personal injury:
• Be sure to stop the engine and remove the key before
checking coolant level.
• Do not remove the radiator cap when the engine is hot.
Loosen cap slightly, to the stop, to relieve any excess
pressure before removing cap completely.
Check the coolant level daily both the radiator and the recovery
tank (4) before starting engine.
1. Remove the radiator cap (1) and check to see that the coolant
level is just below the fill port.
2. Check to see that the coolant level is between the "FULL" and
"LOW" marks of recovery tank (4).
3. When the coolant level drops due to evaporation, add water
only up to just below the fill port of the radiator and the full level
of the recovery tank (4).
In case of leakage, add coolant and water in the specified
mixing ratio up to the full level. (Refer to G-41.)
IMPORTANT
• If the radiator cap has to be removed, follow the caution
above and securely retighten the cap.
• Use clean, distilled coolant and water to fill the radiator and
recovery tank.
(1) Radiator Cap A: FULL
(2) Overflow Pipe B: LOW
(3) Recovery Tank Cap
(4) Recovery Tank
9Y1210595GEG0011US0

G-21

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL
Greasing

CAUTION
To avoid personal injury:
• Be sure to stop the engine and remove the key before
greasing.
(1) Spindle Shaft [A] RCK42GR
(2) Tension Arm [B] RCK42-GR16
(3) Belt Tension Pivot
(4) Mower Universal Joint
(Apply grease on the spline shaft)
9Y1210595GEG0012US0

G-22

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL

[2] CHECK POINTS OF EVERY 50 HOURS


Checking Safety Device [GR1600EU, GR1600F]
The safety Devices in your machine are designs to protect you
while operating. Please check these Safety Devices periodically
- daily is best - to do test function of the Safety Devices before
operation.

CAUTION
• Do not allow anyone near the machine while testing.
• If the machine does not pass one of the following tests, do
not operate the machine.
1. Check the following tests before operating the mower. Sit on the
operator's seat for all tests except for Test 3 and Test 4.
 Safety Start Control 1
1. Depress the brake pedal (3) fully.
2. Engage the PTO lever (4).
3. Turn the key switch (2) to the "START" position.
4. The engine should not crank.
 Safety Start Control 2
1. Disengage the PTO lever (4).
2. Release the brake pedal (3).
3. Turn the key to the "START" position.
4. The engine should not crank.
 Seat Safety Control 1
1. Run the engine at half throttle.
2. Engage the PTO lever (4).
3. Stand up. (Do not get off the machine.)
4. Engine should shut off.
 Seat Start Control 2
1. Run the engine at half throttle.
2. Disengage the PTO lever (4).
3. Release the brake pedal (3).
4. Stand up. (Do not get off the machine.)
5. Engine should shut off.
 PTO Safety Control 1
1. Dismount the grass container (6) from the platform.
2. Run the engine at half throttle.
3. Engage the PTO lever (4).
4. Engine should shut off.
 PTO Safety Control 2
1. Run the engine at half throttle.
2. Engage the PTO lever (4).
3. Dump the grass catcher from grass container (6).
4. Engine should shut off.
 PTO Safety Control 3
1. Open the top cover (5).
2. Run the engine at half throttle.
3. Engage the PTO lever (4).
4. Engine should shut off.
(1) Throttle Lever (4) PTO Lever
(2) Key Switch (5) Top Cover
(3) Brake Pedal (6) Grass Container
9Y1210595GEG0057US0

G-23

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL
Checking Engine Start System [GR1600ID]
The engine Start System in your machine are designed to
protect you while operating. Please check these Engine Start
System periodically - daily is best - to test function of the Engine
Start System before operation.

CAUTION
To avoid personal injury:
• Do not allow anyone near machine while testing.
• If the machine does not pass one of the following tests, do
not operate the machine.
See your local KUBOTA Dealer.
• Sit on operator's for all tests.
IMPORTANT
• Check the following tests before operating the machine.
Test 1 (Safety Start Control 1)
1. Depress the brake pedal fully.
2. Engine the PTO lever.
3. Turn the key switch to the "START" position.
4. The engine should not crank.
Test 2 (Safety Start System Control 2)
1. Disengage the PTO lever.
2. Release the brake pedal.
3. Turn the key to the "START" position.
4. The engine should not crank.
(1) Brake Pedal (3) Key Switch
(2) PTO Lever (4) Throttle Lever
9Y1210595GEG0058US0
Checking OPC System [GR1600ID]
The OPC (Operator Presence Control) system in your machine
are designed to protect you whole operating.
Please check these OPC system periodically - daily is best - to
test function of the OPC system before operation.

CAUTION
To avoid personal injury:
• Do not allow anyone near the machine while testing.
• If the machine does not pass one of the following tests, do
not operating the machine.
See your local KUBOTA dealer.
IMPORTANT
• Check the following tests before operating the machine.
Test1 (Seat Safety Control 1)
1. Run the engine at half throttle.
2. Engage the PTO lever.
3. Stand up. (DO NOT GET OFF THE MACHINE.)
4. Engine should shut off.
Test1 (Seat Safety Control 2)
1. Run the engine at half throttle.
2. Disengage the PTO lever.
3. Release the brake pedal.
4. Stand up. (DO NOT GET OFF THE MACHINE.)
5. Engine should shut off.
(1) Brake Pedal (3) Key Switch
(2) PTO Lever (4) Throttle Lever
9Y1210595GEG0059US0

G-24

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL
Cleaning Air Cleaner Element

CAUTION
To avoid personal injury:
• Be sure to stop engine and remove the key before cleaning
air cleaner element.
1. Remove the air cleaner cover and element.
a) Undo the hook.
b) Turn the cover clockwise and detach it.
2. Clean the element:
a) When dry dust adheres to the element, blow compressed air
from the inside, turning the element. Pressure of
compressed air must be under 210 kPa (2.1 kgf/cm2,
30 psi).
b) When carbon or oil adheres to the element, soak the
element in detergent for 15 minutes, and then wash it
several times in water, rinse with clean water and dry it
naturally. After element is fully dried, inspect the inside of
the element with a light and check if it is damaged or not.
(Referring to the instructions on the label attached to the
case.)
3. Replace the air cleaner element if:
Once yearly or after every sixth cleaning, whichever comes first.
NOTE
• Check to see if the evacuator valve is blocked with dust.
• Operating in dusty conditions requires more frequent
maintenance.
IMPORTANT
• The air cleaner uses a dry element, never apply oil.
• Do not run the engine with the filter element removed.
• Align the arrow marks when reinstalling the cover. If the
cover is improperly fitted, dust passes by the baffle and
directly adheres to the element.
 Evacuator valve
Open the evacuator valve one a week under ordinary conditions
- or daily when used in a dusty place - to get rid of large particles of
dust and dirt.
(1) Air Cleaner Cover (3) Evacuator Valve
(2) Air Cleaner Element
9Y1210595GEG0014US0

G-25

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL
Checking Mower Gear Box Oil Level

CAUTION
To avoid personal injury:
• Always stop the engine and remove the key before
checking oil.
1. Park the machine on a flat surface and lower the mower to the
ground.
2. To check the oil level, loosen filler plug (1) bolt and check to see
that the oil level is just below the oil filler plug (1) port.
3. If the level is too low, add new oil to the prescribed level at the
oil inlet. (Refer to "4. LUBRICANTS, FUEL AND COOLANT" on
page G-9.)
(1) Oil Filler Plug [A] RCK42GR
[B] RCK42-GR16
9Y1210595GEG0015US0

Lubricating All Grease Fitting

CAUTION
To avoid personal injury:
• Be sure to stop the engine and remove the key before
greasing.
1. Apply grease to the following locations as shown in the figures.
(1) Engine Transmission Universal (2) Fitting (LH, RH)
Joint (Spline Shaft) (3) King Pin (LH, RH)
9Y1210595GEG0016US0

G-26

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL
Oiling

CAUTION
To avoid personal injury:
• Be sure to stop the engine and remove the key before
oiling.
1. Apply oil to the following location as shown in the figures.
(1) Mower Universal Joint (4) Seat Adjuster
(2) Speed Control Pedal Shaft (RH) (5) Throttle Cable
(3) Speed Control Pedal Shaft (LH)
(To be continued)

G-27

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL
(Continued)

(6) Around Hole of Mower Link (14) Arm Bracket


(7) Around Pin (15) Quick Clean Lever
(8) Pivot of Mower Link (16) PTO Lever (Fulcrum)
(9) Pivot of Lift Arm (17) Link Fulcrum
(10) Front Link (18) Mower Lift Lever (Fulcrum)
(11) Top Cover Lock Lever
(12) Frame Shaft [A] GR1600EU, GR1600F
(13) Top Cover Hinge
9Y1210595GEG0017US0

G-28

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL
Checking Battery Condition

DANGER
To avoid the possibility of battery explosion:
For the refillable type battery, follow the instructions below.
• Do not use or charge the refillable type battery if the fluid
level is below the LOWER (lower limit level) mark.
Otherwise, the battery component parts may prematurely
deteriorate, which may shorten the battery's service life or
cause an explosion. Check the fluid level regularly and add
distilled water as required so that the fluid level is between
the UPPER and LOWER levels.

DANGER
To avoid personal injury or death:
• When the battery is being activated, hydrogen and oxygen
gases in the battery are extremely explosive. Keep open
sparks and flames away from the battery at all times,
especially when charging the battery.

WARNING
To avoid personal injury:
• Batteries, battery posts, terminals and related accessories
contain lead and lead compounds, and other chemicals
known to the State of California to cause cancer and birth
defects or other reproductive harm, WASH HANDS AFTER
HANDLING.
• Never remove the vent plugs while the engine is running.
• Keep electrolyte away from eyes, hands and clothes. If you
are spattered with it, wash it away completely with water
immediately and get medical attention.
• Wear eye protection and rubber gloves when working
around battery.
1. Mishandling the battery shortens the service life and adds to
maintenance costs.
2. The original battery is maintenance free type battery, but need
some servicing.
3. If the battery is weak, the engine is difficult to start and the lights
become dim. It is important to check the battery periodically.
• When exchanging an old battery for new one, use battery of
equal specification in table below.
Cold Normal
Battery Reserve
Volts (V) Cranking Charging
Type Capacity (min)
Amps Rate (A)
51R 12 80 430 4.5

(1) Battery
(To be continued)

G-29

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL
(Continued)
(For non-accessible maintenance-free type batteries.)
Maintenance-free, non-accessible batteries are designed to
eliminate the need to add water. Yet the volume of electrolyte above
plates may eventually become depleted due to abnormal conditions
such as high heat or improper regulator setting. Use voltmeter to
check the state of charge. (See reference chart below to determine
if charging is necessary.)
Battery voltage Reference state of charge
12.6 100 % (Full charge)
12.4 75 %
12.2 50 %
12.0 25 %
11.8 0%

The factory-installed battery is of non-refillable type.


If the battery is work, charge the battery or replace it with new
one.
9Y1210595GEG0060US0

G-30

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL
Battery Charging

DANGER
To avoid serious injury or death:
• When the battery is being activated, hydrogen and oxygen
gases in the battery are extremely explosive. Keep open
sparks and flames away from the battery at all times,
especially when charging the battery.

WARNING
To avoid serious injury:
• When charging the battery, ensure the vent caps are
securely in place (if equipped).
• When disconnecting the cable from the battery, start with
the negative terminal first.
When connecting the cable to the battery, start with the
positive terminal first.
• Never check battery charge by placing a metal object
across the posts.
Use a voltmeter or hydrometer.
(For accessible maintainable type batteries with removable vent
caps.)
1. Make sure each electrolyte (3) level is to the bottom of vent
wells (4), if necessary add distilled water in a well-ventilated
area.
2. The water in the electrolyte (3) evaporates during recharging.
Liquid shortage damages the battery. Excessive liquid spills
over and damages the machine.
3. To slow charge the battery, connect the battery positive terminal
to the charger positive terminal and the negative to the negative,
then recharge in the standard fashion.
4. A boost charge is only for emergencies. It will partially charges
the battery at a high rate and in a short time.
When using a boost-charged battery, it is necessary to recharge
the battery as early as possible.
Failure to do this will shorten the battery's service life.
5. When the specific gravity of electrolyte (3) become between
1.27 and 1.29 charge has completed.
6. When exchanging an old battery into new one, use battery of
equal specification shown in "SPECIFICATIONS".
 Direction for Storage
1. When storing the machine for long periods of time, remove the
battery from machine, adjust the electrolyte (3) to the proper
level and store in a dry place out of direct sunlight.
2. The battery self-discharges while it is stored. Recharge it once
every three months in hot seasons and once every six months
in cold seasons.
(1) Lowest Level (4) Vent Well
(2) Highest Level (5) Separator
(3) Electrolyte
9Y1210595GEG0061US0

G-31

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL

[3] CHECK POINTS OF EVERY 100 HOURS


Checking Fuel Line and Fuel Filter

CAUTION
To avoid personal injury:
• Be sure to stop the engine and remove the key when
attempting to make the following checks and changes.
• Never fail to check the fuel lines periodically. The fuel lines
are subject to wear and aging. Fuel may leak out onto the
running engine, causing a fire.
The fuel line connections should be checked annually or every
100 service hours, whichever comes first.
1. The fuel line (2) is made of rubber and ages regardless of
service period.
2. If the fuel line (2) and clamps (1) are found to be damaged or
deteriorated, replace them.
3. Check fuel filter (3), if it is clogged by debris or contaminated
with water, replace it.
IMPORTANT
• When the fuel line is disconnected for maintenance or
repair, close both ends of the fuel line with a piece of clean
cloth or paper to prevent dust and dirt from entering. In
addition, particular care must be taken not to admit dust
and dirt into the fuel pump. Entrance of even a small
amount of dust or dirt cause premature wear and
malfunction of the fuel pump and injector components.
(1) Pipe Clamp (3) Fuel Filter
(2) Fuel Line
9Y1210595GEG0021US0

G-32

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL
Checking Brake

CAUTION
To avoid personal injury:
• When making adjustments, park the machine on a flat area,
block wheels, stop the engine and remove the key.
1. Correct free travel ranges from 15 to 25 mm (0.59 to 0.98 in.).
2. If it is not correct, loosen the lock nut (2) and turn the nut (3) in
the desired direction until the proper play is achieved. After
adjustment, retighten lock nut securely.
15 to 25 mm
Play "A" Factory specification
0.59 to 0.98 in.

(1) Brake Pedal [A] GR1600EU, GR1600F


(2) Lock Nut [B] GR1600ID
(3) Nut
(4) Spring
9Y1210595GEG0062US0

G-33

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL
Checking Fan Drive Belt Tension

CAUTION
To avoid personal injury:
• Be sure to stop the engine and remove the key before
checking belt tension.
If the fan drive belt becomes loose, the engine may overheat.
1. To adjust, remove the right cover (1).
2. Then loosen the dynamo mounting screws (3) and move the
dynamo (2) outward to tighten the belt.
3. After adjustment, securely tighten the bolts.
Moderate belt tension:
The belt should deflect approx. 10 mm (0.39 in.) when the
center of the belt is depressed with finger pressure of 98 N (10 kgf).
IMPORTANT
• When replacing the fan drive belt, be careful not to catch it
on the cap under the water pump.
10 mm
Deflection "A" Factory specification
0.39 in.

(1) Right Cover A: Approx. 10 mm (0.39 in.)


(2) Dynamo M: "MOVE"
(3) Dynamo Mounting Screw X: Incorrect Belt Pass
9Y1210595GEG0063US0

G-34

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL

[4] CHECK POINT OF EVERY 150 HOURS


Changing Mower Gear Box Oil

CAUTION
To avoid personal injury:
• Be sure to stop the engine and remove the key before
changing the oil.
1. To drain the used oil, remove the oil filler plug (1) at the mower
gear box, tilt the mower deck and drain the oil completely into
the oil pan.
2. Fill with the new oil. (Refer to "4. LUBRICANTS, FUEL AND
COOLANT" on page G-9.)
3. After filling, reinstall the oil filler plug (1).
(1) Oil Filler Plug [A] RCK42GR
(2) Drain Plug [B] RCK42-GR16
9Y1210595GEG0024US0

[5] CHECK POINTS OF EVERY 200 HOURS


Replacing Engine Oil Filter Cartridge

CAUTION
To avoid personal injury:
• Be sure to stop the engine and remove the key before
changing the oil filter cartridge.
• Allow engine to cool down sufficiently, oil can be hot and
may cause burns.
1. The oil filter cartridge (1) must be changed every 200 service
hours.
2. Apply a slight coat of oil onto the rubber gasket of new cartridge.
3. Tighten the filter quickly until it contacts the mounting surface.
Tighten filter by hand an additional 1/2 turn only.
4. After the cartridge has been replaced, the engine oil level
normally lowers a little. Add engine oil to proper level. Check for
oil leaks around filter gasket.
IMPORTANT
• To prevent serious damage to the engine, element of
recommended type must be used. Use only a genuine
KUBOTA filter or its equivalent.
(1) Engine Oil Filter Cartridge
9Y1210595GEG0025US0

G-35

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL
Changing Engine Oil

CAUTION
To avoid personal injury:
• Be sure to stop the engine and remove the key before
changing the oil.
• Allow engine to cool down sufficiently; oil can be hot and
may cause burns.
1. To keep dirt, debris, etc., out of the engine, clean the area
around the oil fill cap/dipstick before removing it.
2. Remove the oil drain plug, the oil fill cap, and the dipstick. Be
sure to allow ample time for complete drainage.
3. The used oil can be drained out more easily if the engine is
warm.
4. Reinstall the drain plug. Make sure it is tightened to 13.6 N·m
torque.
5. Fill the crankcase, with new oil of the proper type, to the "F"
mark on the dipstick. (See "4. LUBRICANTS, FUEL AND
COOLANT" on page G-9.) Always check the level with the
dipstick before adding more oil.
6. To check the oil level. Remove the dipstick, wipe it clean, insert
it and draw it out again. Check to see that the oil level is between
the two marks.
7. Reinstall the oil fill cap and tighten it securely. Reinstall the
dipstick.
NOTE
• To prevent extensive engine wear or damage, always
maintain the proper oil level in the crankcase. Never
operate the engine with the oil level below "LOWER
LEVEL" or over "UPPER LEVEL" on the dipstick.
1.2 L
Engine oil Capacity 1.3 U.S.qts
1.1 Imp.qts

(1) Drain Plug A: UPPER LEVEL


(2) Engine Oil Port B: LOWER LEVEL
(3) Oil Level Dipstick
9Y1210595GEG0020US0

G-36

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL
Replacing Transmission Oil Filter Cartridge

CAUTION
To avoid personal injury:
• Be sure to stop the engine before changing the oil filter
cartridge.
• Allow transmission case to cool down sufficiently; oil can
be hot and may cause burns.
1. The transmission oil filter cartridge (1) must be changed every
200 service hours.
2. Remove the grass container and clean the area indicated.
3. Remove the oil filter cartridge (1) with the filter wrench.
4. Lightly tighten the screw (2) by using a screwdriver.
5. Apply a slight coat of oil onto the cartridge gasket.
6. Tighten the filter quickly until it contacts the mounting surface.
Tighten filter by hand an additional 1/2 turn only.
7. Assemble the cover and mount the grass container.
8. After the new cartridge has been replaced, the transmission
fluid level normally lowers a little. Add fluid to proper level.
Check for oil leaks around filter gasket.
IMPORTANT
• To prevent serious damage to hydraulic system, the
replacement filter must be a highly efficient, 10 µm filter.
Use only a genuine KUBOTA filter or its equivalent.
(1) Transmission Oil Filter Cartridge [A] GR1600EU, GR1600F
(2) Screw [B] GR1600ID
9Y1210595GEG0028US0

Checking Radiator Hose and Hose Clamp


Check to see if radiator hoses are properly fixed every
200 hours of operation or six months, whichever comes first.
1. If hose clamps are loose or water leaks, tighten bands securely.
2. Radiator hoses (2) and tighten hose clamps securely, if radiator
hoses (2) are swollen, hardened or cracked.
(1) Radiator Core (2) Radiator Hose
9Y1210595GEG0029US0

G-37

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL
Adjusting Front Axle Pivot
1. Jack up the front of machine.
2. Tighten the center pin locking nut (1) with specified torque.
3. Measure the clearance between the front axle frame (2) and
anti-vibration bolt (3).
4. If the measurement exceeds the factory specification, adjust the
anti-vibration bolt.
77.4 to 90.2 N·m
Tightening torque Center pin locking nut 7.90 to 9.19 kgf·m
57.1 to 66.5 lbf·ft

Clearance between front


0.30 to 0.50 mm
axle frame and Factory specification
0.012 to 0.019 in.
anti-vibration bolt "A"

(1) Center Pin Locking Nut A: Clearance


(2) Front Axle Frame
(3) Anti-vibration Bolt
9Y1210595GEG0031US0

Checking Intake Air Line


1. Check to see that hose (1) and clamps (2) are tight and not
damaged.
2. If hose (1) and clamps (2) are found worn or damaged, replace
or repair them at once.
(1) Hose (2) Clamp
9Y1210595GEG0032US0

G-38

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL

[6] CHECK POINTS OF EVERY 400 HOURS


Changing Transmission Fluid

CAUTION
To avoid personal injury:
• Be sure to stop the engine and remove the key before
changing or checking the oil.
• Allow transmission case to cool down sufficiently; oil can
be hot and may cause burns.
The fluid in the transmission case is also used for the
hydrostatic drive system.
1. To drain the transmission oil, place oil pan underneath the
transmission case and remove the drain plug (2).
2. After draining, disassemble and clean the strainer (5) and
change the oil filter cartridge (7). After reassembling, fill with
UDT or SUPER UDT hydrostatic transmission fluid, or its
equivalent.
3. Remove the oil plug and fill with the new oil.
4. After running the engine for a few minutes, stop it and check the
oil level again; add oil to the prescribed level.
IMPORTANT
• Operate only at low rpm immediately after changing the
transmission fluid and filter cartridge.
Keep the engine at medium speed for a few minutes to
insure proper lubrication of all parts so that there is no
damage to transmission.
• Do not engage PTO before checking the oil level.
2.8 L
Transmission fluid Capacity 0.74 U.S.gals
0.62 Imp.gals

(1) Suction Pipe A: Oil level is acceptable within this


(2) Drain Plug range.
(3) O-ring (Small) [A] GR1600EU, GR1600F
(4) O-ring (Large) [B] GR1600ID
(5) Strainer
(6) Boss
(7) Transmission Oil Filter Cartridge
(8) Dipstick
9Y1210595GEG0026US0

G-39

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL
Cleaning Transmission Strainer
When changing the transmission fluid, disassemble and rinse
the strainer with nonflammable solvent to completely clean off
filings.
Check O-rings (2), (3), replace if damaged, cracked or
hardened.When reassembling be careful not to damage the parts.
NOTE
• Since the fine filings in the oil can damage the precision
component parts of the hydraulic system, the end of the
suction line is provided with an oil strainer.
(1) Suction Pipe (4) Strainer
(2) O-ring (Small) (5) Boss
(3) O-ring (Large)
9Y1210595GEG0027US0
Replacing Fuel Filter
1. Disconnect the fuel hoses and loosen the filter band to replace
the fuel filter (3).
NOTE
• If the fuel line is removed, be sure to properly bleed the fuel
system. (Refer to G-32.)
(1) Pipe Clamps (3) Fuel Filter
(2) Fuel Line
9Y1210595GEG0033US0

[7] CHECK POINT OF EVERY 1500 HOURS


Checking Fuel Injection Nozzle (Injection Pressure)
1. Check the fuel injection nozzle.
Refer to "[1] CHECKING AND ADJUSTING" on page 1-S10.
9Y1210595GEG0034US0

[8] CHECK POINT OF EVERY 3000 HOURS


Checking Injection Pump
1. Check the fuel system.
Refer to "(4) Fuel System" on page 1-S16.
9Y1210595GEG0053US0

G-40

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL

[9] CHECK POINTS OF EVERY 1 YEAR


Replacing Air Cleaner Element
1. Change the element once a year.
9Y1210595GEG0035US0
Flushing Cooling System and Changing Coolant

CAUTION
To avoid personal injury:
• Do not remove the radiator cap when the engine is hot.
Then loosen cap slightly to the stop to relieve any excess
pressure before removing cap completely.
1. Stop the engine and let cool down.
2. To drain the coolant, remove the radiator drain plug (1) and
engine drain plug (2) and the hose, and remove the radiator
cap. The radiator cap must be removed to completely drain the
coolant.
3. After all coolant is drained, install the hose with the clamp.
4. Fill with clean water and cooling system cleaner.
5. Follow directions of the cleaner instruction.
6. After flushing, fill with clean water and anti-freeze until the
coolant level is just below the fill port on the radiator. Install the
radiator cap securely.
7. Fill with coolant up to "FULL" mark on the recovery tank.
8. Start and operate the engine for a few minutes.
9. Stop the engine and let cool. Check coolant level of recovery
tank (3) and add coolant if necessary.
IMPORTANT
• Do not start engine without coolant.
• Use clean, fresh water and anti-freeze to fill the radiator and
recovery tank.
• When the anti-freeze is mixed with water, the anti-freeze
mixing ratio must be less than 50 %.
• Securely tighten radiator cap. If the cap is loose or
improperly fitted, water may leak out and the engine could
overheat.
• Refer to "4. LUBRICANTS, FUEL AND COOLANT" on page
G-9.
2.35 L
Coolant
Capacity 2.48 U.S.qts
(with recovery tank)
2.07 Imp.qts

(1) Radiator Drain Plug a: FULL


(2) Engine Drain Plug b: LOW
(3) Recovery Tank
(To be continued)

G-41

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL
(Continued)
 Anti-freeze

CAUTION
To avoid personal injury:
• When using anti-freeze, put on some protection such as
rubber gloves (Anti-freeze contains poison.).
• If should drink anti-freeze, throw up at once and take
medical attention.
• When anti-freeze comes in contact with the skin or
clothing, wash it off immediately.
• Do not mix different types of anti-freeze. The mixture can
produce chemical reaction causing harmful substances.
• Anti-freeze is extremely flammable and explosive under
certain conditions. Keep fire and children away from
anti-freeze.
• When draining fluids from the engine, place some
container underneath the engine body.
• Do not pour waste onto the grounds, down a drain, or into
any water source.
• Observe the relevant environmental protection regulations
when disposing of anti-freeze.
If it freezes, coolant can damage the cylinders and radiator. If
the ambient temperature falls below 0 °C or before a long-term
storage, let out coolant completely, or mix fresh water with long-life
coolant (hereafter LLC) and fill the radiator and reserve tank with
the mixture.
1. Long-life coolant comes in several types. Use ethylene glycol
(EG) type for this engine.
2. Before employing LLC-mixed coolant, fill the radiator with fresh
water and empty it again. Repeat this procedure 2 or 3 times to
clean up the inside.
3. Mixing the LLC
Put the LLC in coolant in the percentage (%) for a target
temperature. When mixing, stir it up well, and then fill into the
radiator.
4. The procedure for the mixing of water and anti-freeze differs
according to the make of the anti-freeze and the ambient
temperature. Refer to SAE J1034 standard, more specifically
also to SAE J814c.
IMPORTANT
• When the anti-freeze is mixed with water, the anti-freeze
mixing ratio must be less than 50 %.
Freezing Point Boiling Point*
Vol % Anti-freeze
°C (°F) °C (°F)
40 −24 (−12) 106 (222)
50 −37 (−34) 108 (226)

*At 0.1013 MPa (760 mmHg) pressure (atmospheric).


A higher boiling point is obtained by using a radiator pressure
cap which permits the development of pressure within the cooling
system.
(To be continued)

G-42

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL
(Continued)
5. Adding the LLC
(1) Add only water if the mixture reduces in amount by
evaporation.
(2) If there is a mixture leak, add the LLC the same manufacture
and type in the same mixture percentage.
*Never add any long-life coolant of different manufacture.
(Different brands may have different additive components, and
the engine may fail to perform as specified.)
6. When the LLC is mixed, do not employ any radiator cleaning
agent. The LLC contains anti-corrosive agent. If mixed with the
cleaning agent, sludge may build up, adversely affecting the
engine parts.
7. KUBOTA's genuine long-life coolant has a service life of
2 years. Be sure to change the coolant every 2 years.
NOTE
• The above data represent industry standards that
necessitate a minimum glycol content in the concentrated
anti-freeze.
• When the coolant level drops due to evaporation, add water
only to keep the anti-freeze mixing ratio less than 50 %. In
case of leakage, add anti-freeze and water in the specified
mixing ratio before filling in to the radiator.
9Y1210595GEG0064US0

G-43

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL

[10] CHECK POINTS OF EVERY 2 YEARS


Replacing Fuel Lines
1. Replace the fuel line.
Refer to G-32.
9Y1210595GEG0038US0
Replacing Engine Breather Hose
1. Replace the engine breather hose.
Refer to 1-M1.
9Y1210595GEG0039US0
Replacing Radiator Hose
1. Replace hoses and clap bands every 2 years or earlier if
checked and found that hoses are swollen, hardened or
cracked.
9Y1210595GEG0040US0
Replacing Intake Air Line
1. Replace the intake air line.
Refer to G-38.
9Y1210595GEG0041US0
Replacing Mower Gear Box Oil Seals
1. Replace the mower gear box oil seals.
Refer to "[3] DISASSEMBLING AND ASSEMBLING" on page
7-S14.
9Y1210595GEG0042US0

G-44

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL

[11] SERVICE AS REQUIRED


Replacing Fuses
1. Open the hood.
2. Remove the blown fuse.
3. Place a new 3 A, 10 A, 15 A fuse or 40 A slow blow fuse in
position.
NOTE
• Never "jump" the fuse with wire or foil, or install a larger
capacity fuse than is recommended.
 Protected Circuit
Fuse No. (ID Label) Capacity (A) Protected circuit
Engine Stop (a) 15 Engine stop timer relay
Fuel pump, head light, power
(1) IG/M (b) 10
steering control unit, etc.
OPC (c) 3 OPC
Slow blow fuse Check circuit against wrong
(2) –
40 battery connection

(1) Fuse Location (a) Engine Stop


(2) Slow Blow Fuse (b) IG/M
(c) OPC
9Y1210595GEG0043US0
Replacing Bulbs
(A)Replacement of the head light bulb
1. Open the hood.
2. Turn bulb socket to remove socket from head light housing.
3. Push bulb down and turn one quarter turn to remove bulb from
the socket.
4. Install new bulb to the socket.
5. Install the socket in housing.
6. Close the hood.
Head light bulb 24 W

(B) Replacement of the indicator light bulb


1. Open the hood.
2. Turn bad bulb socket to the left. And remove it.
3. Pull bulb from the socket.
4. Push new bulb into the socket.
5. Install the socket.
6. Close the hood.
14.0 rated voltage / 0.27
Indicator light bulb
AMP/2 MSCP
9Y1210595GEG0044US0
Bleeding Fuel System
Air must be removed:
1. When the fuel filter or lines are removed.
2. When tank is completely empty.
3. After the machine has not been used for a long period of time.
Bleeding procedure is as follows:
1. Fill the fuel tank with fuel.
2. Turn the key switch to the "ON" position and hold it for about
10 seconds.
3. Start the engine and run for about 30 seconds, and then stop
the engine.
9Y1210595GEG0047US0

G-45

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL

[12] MOWER
(1) RCK42GREU, RCK42GRF
Checking and Replacing Mower Blade

WARNING
To avoid serious injury:
• Be sure to stop the engine and remove the key.
• Blades may be sharp. When you handle blades, wear heavy
gloves or wrap end of blade with a rag.
Before checking or replacing the blade, wipe grass and mud off
the top and inside of the mower. Especially clean up the inside of
the belt cover, because otherwise the belt life will be reduced.
 Checking Blade
1. The blade cutting edges should be kept sharp at all times.
Sharpen the cutting edges, if they resemble blade (b). Replace
the blades if they appear similar to blade (c).
 Replacing Blade
1. Remove the mower deck from the machine and turn it over to
expose the blades (4).
2. Wedge a block of wood (1) between the blade (4) and mower
housing as illustrated.
3. The blade bolt (2) has right hand threads, turn counterclockwise
to loosen.
The blade bolt (2) has left hand threads, turn clockwise to
loosen.
4. To sharpen the blades yourself, clamp the blade securely in a
vise.
Use a large mill file and file along the original bevel until sharp.
5. To check the blade for balance, place a small rod though the
centre hole. If the blade is not balanced, file the heavy side of
the blade until balance is achieved.
6. To attach blades (4), be sure to install the 2 cup washers (5)
between the blade (4) and bolt (2) head.
IMPORTANT
• Use the proper size box or socket wrench to tighten or
loosen the blade mounting bolt.
NOTE
• Make sure that the cup washer is not flattened out or worn;
this may cause blade to slip excessively. Replace the 2 cup
washers if either is damaged.
103 to 118 N·m
Tightening torque Blade mounting bolt 10.5 to 12.0 kgf·m
76.0 to 87.0 lbf·ft

(1) Block (a) New Blade


(2) Blade Bolt (b) Worn Blade
(3) Spindle Holder (c) Cracked Blade
(4) Blade
(5) 2-cup Washer A: Loosen
(6) Shim B: 30 mm (1.2 in.)
(7) Spindle Guard
9Y1210595GEG0065US0

G-46

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL
Replacing Mower Belt
1. Remove the mower deck from the machine.
2. Remove the left and right hand shield (4), (5) from the mower
deck. [RCK42GRF only]
3. Clean around the pulleys to remove the belt (3) from the pulleys.
Slip the belt (3) over the top of the left side pulley.
4. Remove the both brackets which mounts the gear box (6) to the
mower deck.
5. To install a new belt, reverse the above procedure.
79 to 90 N·m
Bolt (1) 8.0 to 9.2 kgf·m
58 to 66 lbf·ft
Tightening torque
48 to 55 N·m
Bolt and Nut (2) 4.9 to 5.7 kgf·m
36 to 41 lbf·ft

(1) Bolt (4) Left Hand Shield


(2) Bolt, Nut (5) Right Hand Shield
(3) Belt (6) Mower Gear Box
9Y1210595GEG0046US0

G-47

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL

(2) RCK42-GR16
Checking and Replacing Blade

WARNING
To avoid serious injury:
• Be sure to step the engine and remove the key.
• Blades may be sharp. When you handle blades, wear heavy
gloves or wrap and of blade with a
Before checking or replacing the blade, wipe grass and mud off
the top and inside of the mower.
Especially clean up the inside of the belt cover, because
otherwise the belt life will be reduced.
 Checking
The blade cutting edges should be kept sharp at all times.
Sharpen the cutting edged, if they resemble blade (B).
Replace the blades if they appear similar to blade (C).
(A) New Blade (C) Cracked Blade
(B) Worn Blade
9Y1210595GEG0066US0
Replacing
1. Remove the mower deck from the machine and turn it over to
expose the blades.
2. Wedge a block (1) of wood between the blade (2), (3) and
mower housing as illustrated.
3. The bolt (5) for black blade has right hand threads, turn
counterclockwise to loosen.
The bolt (6) for red blade has left hand threads, turn clockwise
to loosen.
NOTE
• Use the proper size box or socket wrench to tighten or
loosen the blade mounting bolt.
• Black blade (2) to be assembled at discharge deflector
(Black color) side.
Red blade (3) to be assembled at mower deck wall (Red
color) side.
4. To sharpen the blades yourself, clamp the blade securely in a
vise.
Use a large mill file and file along the original bevel until sharp.
5. To check the blade for balance, place a small rod through the
center hole. If the blade is not balanced, file the heavy side of
the blade until balance is achieved.
6. To attach blades, be sure to install the two cup washers and two
plain washers between the blade and bolt head.
NOTE
• Make sure that the cup washer is not flattened out or worn;
this may cause blade to slip excessively.
Replace the two cup washers if either is damaged.
IMPORTANT
• Tighten the 2 blade bolts (5), (6) to 98 to 117.6 N·m (10 to
12 kgf·m, 73 to 86 lbf·ft) of torque.
(1) Block (8) 2-cup Washer
(2) Blade (Black) (9) Plain Washer
(3) Blade (Red) (10) Spindle Guard
(4) Discharge Deflector
(5) Bolt (Right Hand Thread) (A) "Loosen"
(6) Bolt (Left Hand Thread) (L) 30 mm (1.2 in.)
(7) Spindle Holder
9Y1210595GEG0067US0

G-48

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL
Mower Belt Replacement
1. Remove the mower deck from the machine according to the
procedure "DISMOUNTING THE MOWER DECK".
2. Remove the all shields from the mower deck.
3. Clean around the pulleys to remove the belt (1) from the pulleys.
Slip the belt over the top of the pulley.
4. Remove the right bracket (3) which mounts the gear box (2) to
the mower deck.
NOTE
• Tighten each bolt and nut with following torque.
– Bolt M12:
77.6 to 90.2 N·m (8.0 to 9.2 kgf·m, 58 to 66 lbf·ft)
– Bolt M10 and Nut M10:
48.1 to 55.9 N·m (4.9 to 5.7 kgf·m, 36 to 41 lbf·ft)
5. To install a new belt, reverse the above procedure.
(1) Belt (4) M12 Bolt
(2) Gear Box (5) M10 Nut
(3) Right Bracket
9Y1210595GEG0068US0

G-49

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL

8. SPECIAL TOOLS
[1] SPECIAL TOOLS FOR ENGINE
Special Use Puller Set
Code No.
• 07916-09032
Application
• Use exclusively to pull out bearing, gears and other parts with
ease.
WSM000001GEG0011US0

Piston Ring Compressor


Code No.
• 07909-32111
Application
• Use exclusively to push in the piston with piston rings into the
cylinder.
WSM000001GEG0012US0

Piston Ring Tool


Code No.
• 07909-32121
Application
• Use exclusively to remove or install the piston ring with ease.
WSM000001GEG0013US0

G-50

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL

Diesel Engine Compression Tester (for Injection Nozzle)


Code No.
• 07909-30208 (Assembly)
• 07909-30934 (A to F)
• 07909-31211 (E and F)
• 07909-31231 (H)
• 07909-31251 (G)
• 07909-31271 (I)
• 07909-31281 (J)
Application
• Use to measure diesel engine compression and diagnostics of
need for major overhaul.
(1) Gauge (7) Adaptor F
(2) L Joint (8) Adaptor G
(3) Adaptor A (9) Adaptor H
(4) Adaptor B (10) Adaptor I
(5) Adaptor C (11) Adaptor J
(6) Adaptor E
WSM000001GEG0014US0
Oil Pressure Tester
Code No.
• 07916-32032
Application
• Use to measure lubricating oil pressure.
(1) Gauge (5) Adaptor 2
(2) Cable (6) Adaptor 3
(3) Threaded Joint (7) Adaptor 4
(4) Adaptor 1 (8) Adaptor 5
WSM000001GEG0015US0

Valve Seat Cutter


Code No.
• 07909-33102
Application
• Use to reseat valves.
Angle
• 0.79 rad (45 °)
• 0.26 rad (15 °)
Diameter
• 28.6 mm (1.13 in.)
• 31.6 mm (1.24 in.)
• 35.0 mm (1.38 in.)
• 38.0 mm (1.50 in.)
• 41.3 mm (1.63 in.)
• 50.8 mm (2.00 in.)
WSM000001GEG0016US0
Radiator Tester
Code No.
• 07909-31551
Application
• Use to check of radiator cap pressure, and leaks from cooling
system.
Remarks
• Adaptor (1) BANZAI Code No. RCT-2A-30S.
(1) Adaptor
WSM000001GEG0017US0

G-51

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL
Connecting Rod Alignment Tool
Code No.
• 07909-31661
Application
• Use to check the connecting rod alignment.
Applicable range
• Connecting rod big end I.D.
30 to 75 mm dia. (1.2 to 2.9 in. dia.)
• Connecting rod length
65.0 to 300 mm (2.56 to 11.8 in.)
WSM000001GEG0020US0
Nozzle Tester
Code No.
• 07909-31361
Application
• Use to check the fuel injection pressure and spray pattern of
nozzle.
Measuring range
• 0 to 50 MPa (0 to 500 kgf/cm2, 0 to 7200 psi)
WSM000001GEG0021US0

Plastigauge
Code No.
• 07909-30241
Application
• Use to check the oil clearance between crankshaft and bearing,
etc..
Measuring range
• Green: 0.03 to 0.07 mm (0.001 to 0.003 in.)
• Red: 0.05 to 0.1 mm (0.002 to 0.006 in.)
• Blue: 0.1 to 0.2 mm (0.004 to 0.009 in.)
WSM000001GEG0022US0
Red Check
Code No.
• 07909-31371
Application
• Use to check cracks on cylinder head, cylinder block, etc..
WSM000001GEG0023US0

NOTE
• The following special tools are not prevented, so make them referring to the figure.
9Y1210604GEG0052US0

G-52

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL
Injection Pump Pressure Tester
Application
• Use to check fuel tightness of injection pumps.
Pressure gauge full scale:
A
More than 29.4 MPa (300 kgf/cm2, 4270 psi)
B PF 1/2
C Copper gasket
D Flange (Material Steel)
E Hex. nut 27 mm (1.1 in.) across the plat
F Adhesive application
G Fillet welding on the enter circumference
H Retaining nut
I 17 mm dia. (0.67 in. dia.)
J 8.0 mm dia. (0.31 in. dia.)
K 1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
L 17 mm dia. (0.67 in. dia.)
M 6.10 to 6.20 mm dia. (0.241 to 0.244 in. dia.)
N 8.0 mm (0.31 in.)
O 4.0 mm (0.16 in.)
P 11.97 to 11.99 mm dia. (0.4713 to 0.4720 in. dia.)
Q PF 1/2
R 23 mm (0.91 in.)
S 17 mm (0.67 in.)
T 4.0 mm (0.16 in.)
U 12.00 to 12.02 mm dia. (0.4725 to 0.4732 in. dia.)
V 100 mm (3.94 in.)
W M12 × P1.5
X 5.0 mm (0.20 in.)
9Y1210604GEG0053US0
Valve Guide Replacing Tool
Application
• Use to press out and press fit the valve guide.
A 220 mm (8.66 in.)
B 80 mm (3.1 in.)
C 40 mm (1.6 in.)
D 20 mm dia. (0.79 in. dia.)
E 9.960 to 9.980 mm dia. (0.3922 to 0.3929 in. dia.)
F 5.50 to 5.70 mm dia. (0.217 to 0.224 in. dia.)
G 25 mm dia. (0.98 in. dia.)
H 6.00 to 6.10 mm dia. (0.237 to 0.240 in. dia.)
I 5.0 mm (0.20 in.)
J 18 mm dia. (0.71 in. dia.)
K 10.6 to 10.7 mm dia. (0.418 to 0.421 in. dia.)
L 6.90 to 7.10 mm (0.272 to 0.279 in.)
C1 Chamfer 1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
C2 Chamfer 2.0 mm (0.079 in.)
C0.3 Chamfer 0.3 mm (0.01 in.)
9Y1210604GEG0054US0

G-53

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL
Bushing Replacing Tools
Application
• Use to press out and to press fit the bushing.
1. For small end bushing
A 145 mm (5.71 in.)
B 20 mm (0.79 in.)
C 100 mm (3.94 in.)
D 19.90 to 19.95 mm dia. (0.7835 to 0.7854 in. dia.)
E 21.90 to 21.95 mm dia. (0.8622 to 0.8641 in. dia.)
F 25 mm dia. (0.98 in. dia.)
C1 Chamfer 1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
C2 Chamfer 2.0 mm (0.079 in.)
C0.3 Chamfer 0.3 mm (0.012 in.)
a 6.3 µm (250 µin.)
b 6.3 µm (250 µin.)
2. For idle gear bushing
A 150 mm (5.91 in.)
B 23 mm (0.91 in.)
C 100 mm (3.94 in.)
D 19.90 to 19.95 mm dia. (0.7835 to 0.7854 in. dia.)
E 21.90 to 21.95 mm dia. (0.8622 to 0.8641 in. dia.)
F 25 mm dia. (0.98 in. dia.)
C1 Chamfer 1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
C2 Chamfer 2.0 mm (0.079 in.)
C0.3 Chamfer 0.3 mm (0.01 in.)
a 6.3 µm (250 µin.)
b 6.3 µm (250 µin.)
9Y1210604GEG0055US0
Flywheel Stopper
Application
• Use to loosen and tighten the flywheel screw.
A 20 mm (0.79 in.)
B 15 mm (0.59 in.)
C 10 mm dia. (0.39 in. dia.)
D 30 mm (1.2 in.)
E 8.0 mm (0.31 in.)
F 200 mm (7.87 in.)
9Y1210604GEG0056US0

G-54

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL
Crankshaft Bearing 1 Replacing Tool
Application
• Use to press out and press fit the crankshaft bearing 1.
[Press Out]
A 135 mm (5.31 in.)
B 72 mm (2.8 in.)
C 40 mm radius (1.6 in. radius)
D 10 mm (0.39 in.)
E 22 mm (0.87 in.)
F 20 mm dia. (0.79 in. dia.)
G 47.90 to 47.95 mm dia. (1.886 to 1.887 in. dia.)
H 43.90 to 43.95 mm dia. (1.729 to 1.730 in. dia.)
C1 Chamfer 1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
C2 Chamfer 2.0 mm (0.079 in.)
C0.3 Chamfer 0.3 mm (0.01 in.)

[Press Fit]
A 130 mm (5.12 in.)
B 72 mm (2.8 in.)
C 40 mm radius (1.6 in. radius)
D 9.0 mm (0.35 in.)
E 24 mm (0.94 in.)
F 20 mm dia. (0.79 in. dia.)
G 68 mm dia. (2.7 in. dia.)
H 39.90 to 39.95 mm dia. (1.571 to 1.572 in. dia.)
C1 Chamfer 1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
C2 Chamfer 2.0 mm (0.079 in.)
C0.3 Chamfer 0.3 mm (0.01 in.)

9Y1210604GEG0057US0

G-55

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL

[2] SPECIAL TOOLS FOR MACHINE


Relief Valve Pressure Tester
Code No.
• 07916-50045
Application
• This allows easy measurement of relief valve setting pressure.
(1) Gauge (07916-50322) (6) Adaptor C (PS3/8) (07916-50371)
(2) Cable (07916-50331) (7) Adaptor D (PT1/8) (07916-50381)
(3) Threaded Joint (07916-50401) (8) Adaptor E (PS3/8) (07916-50392)
(4) Threaded Joint (07916-50341) (9) Adaptor F (PF1/2) (07916-62601)
(5) Adaptor B (M18 × P1.5) (10) Adaptor 58 (PT1/4) (07916-52391)
(07916-50361)
9Y1210498GEG0052US0
Hydrostatic Transmission Tester and HST Adaptor Set
Code No.
• 07916-52040 (Hydrostatic Transmission Tester)
• 07916-53072 (HST Adaptor Set)
Application
• This allows easy measurement of hydrostatic transmission
hydraulic pressure.
(1) Hydrostatic Transmission Tester (8) Valve Seat Driver (07916-60841)
(07916-52040) (9) Connector 1 (07916-60811)
(2) Gasket (04714-00200) (10) Connector 2 (07916-60821)
(3) Connector 3 (07916-51331) (11) Long Connector (07916-60831)
(4) Vacuum Gauge (07916-51331) (12) Adaptor 1 (07916-52621)
(5) Pressure Gauge (Low Pressure) (13) Adaptor 2 with Collar
(07916-51301) (07916-52632)
(6) Pressure Gauge (High Pressure) (14) Adaptor 3 with Collar
(in Relief Valve Set Pressure (07916-52642)
Tester) (15) HST Adaptor Set
(07916-50321) (07916-53072)
(7) HN Tube (in Relief Valve Set
Pressure Tester) (07916-50331)
9Y1210498GEG0053US0

G-56

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL
HST Relief Pressure Gauge Adaptors (Adaptor 1)
Application
• This allows easy measurement of hydrostatic transmission hydraulic pressure.
5.94 to 6.00 mm dia.
A
(0.234 to 0.236 in. dia.)
8.165 to 8.187 mm dia.
B
(0.3215 to 0.3223 in. dia.)
C 8.4 mm dia. (0.3307 in. dia.)
D 8.2 mm (0.32 in.)
E 14.2 mm (0.55905 in.)
F 7.6 to 8.0 mm (0.30 to 0.31 in.)
G 2.3 mm (0.09055 in.)
H 2.0 to 2.2 mm (0.079 to 0.087 in.)
I 0.26 rad (15 °)
J M8
K 3 mm dia. drill (0.12 in. dia. drill)
L Rc1/8
M 2.09 rad (120 °)
N 11.8 to 11.9 mm (0.465 to 0.469 in.)
O 12.2 mm (0.480 in.)
P 2 mm (0.079 in.)
Q 3 mm (0.118 in.)
R 8 mm (0.31496 in.)
S 2 mm (0.079 in.)
T 2 mm (0.079 in.)
U 17.4625 mm dia. (0.6875 in. dia.)
V 7.7 mm (0.303 in.)
W 10.7 mm (0.421 in.)
C0.5 Chamfer 0.5 mm (0.020 in.)
R0.4 Radius 0.4 mm (0.016 in.)
R0.1 Radius 0.1 mm (0.004 in.)
9Y1210498GEG0043US0

G-57

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL
HST Relief Pressure Gauge Adaptors (Adaptor 2)

A 10 mm (0.394 in.)
B 3 mm (0.1181 in.)
C 2.0 to 2.4 mm (0.079 to 0.094 in.)
D 3 mm (0.12 in.)
E 5.8 mm (0.23 in.)
F 1.5 mm (0.06 in.)
G 9 mm dia. (0.35 in. dia.)
8.200 to 8.215 mm dia.
H
(0.3228 to 0.3234 in. dia.)
I 9.2 mm dia. (0.16 in. dia.)
12.16 to 12.29 mm dia.
J
(0.4787 to 0.4839 in. dia.)
17.6 to 17.8 mm dia.
K
(0.693 to 0.701 in. dia.)
L 0.52 rad (30 °)
M 9/16-18UNF
N M8
O 1.5 mm (0.059 in.)
10.3 to 10.5 mm
P
(0.4055 to 0.4134 in.)
Q 2.09 rad (120 °)
C1 Chamfer 1 mm (0.039 in.)
C0.2 Chamfer 0.2 mm (0.008 in.)
R0.4 Radius 0.4 mm (0.016 in.)
R0.2 Radius 0.2 mm (0.008 in.)
9Y1210498GEG0044US0
HST Relief Pressure Gauge Adaptors (Adaptor Lever)
Application
• This allows easy installation and removal of the adaptor 2 from
HST center section.
A 9.7 to 10.3 mm (0.382 to 0.406 in.)
B 1 mm (0.0472 in.)
C 10.6 to 10.9 mm (0.417 to 0.429 in.)
D 100 mm (3.94 in.)
E 12 mm (0.47 in.)
F 2 mm (0.08 in.)
R1.2 Radius 1.2 mm (0.047 in.)
R1 Radius 1 mm (0.039 in.)
9Y1210498GEG0045US0

G-58

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL
Short Neck Wrench
Application
• This allows easy removal and installation of the hexagon socket
head plug from the HST center section.
A 90 mm (3.543 in.)
B 7 to 8 mm (0.28 to 0.31 in.)
C 11 mm (0.433 in.)
D 6.35 mm (0.25 in.)
R6.4 Radius 6.4 mm (0.252 in.)
9Y1210498GEG0046US0
PTO Brake Assembling Template
NOTE
• The thickness of this is 1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
A 76.5 mm (3.01 in.)
B 33.5 mm (1.32 in.)
C 67.9 to 68.1 mm (2.67 to 2.68 in.)
D 25.4 to 25.6 mm (1.00 to 1.01 in.)
E 57.4 to 57.6 mm (2.26 to 2.27 in.)
F 21.4 to 21.6 mm (0.843 to 0.850 in.)
G 15 mm (0.59 in.)
H 115 mm (4.53 in.)
I 103.4 to 103.6 mm (4.071 to 4.078 in.)
J 47.4 to 47.6 mm (1.866 to 1.874 in.)
K 44.9 to 45.1 mm (1.77 to 1.78 in.)
L 15.4 to 15.6 mm (0.607 to 0.614 in)
M 83.6 to 84.1 mm dia. (3.30 to 3.31 in. dia.)
N 72.15 to 72.45 mm dia. (2.841 to 2.852 in. dia.)
O 4.9 mm (0.19 in.)
P 33.9 to 34.1 mm (1.33 to 1.34 in.)
Q 5.3 to 5.7 mm (0.21 to 0.22 in.)
R 11.7 to 11.9 mm (0.461 to 0.468 in.)
S 2.3536 to 2.3588 rad (134.85 to 135.15 °)
T 1.569 to 1.573 rad (89.85 to 90.15 °)
U 0.4338 to 0.4389 rad (24.85 to 25.15 °)
V 6 × 8.2 mm dia. (6 × 0.32 in. dia.)
C1 Chamfer 1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
9Y1210498GEG0047US0

G-59

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL

9. TIRES
[1] TIRE PRESSURE
CAUTION
To avoid personal injury:
• Do not attempt to mount a tire on a rim. This should be done by a qualified person with the proper
equipment.
• Always maintain the correct tire pressure.
Do not inflate tires above the recommended pressure as shown below.
• Inflation pressure in front tires vises quickly when using compressed air.
IMPORTANT
• Do not use tires larger than specified.
Recommended Inflation
Tire sizes
Max. pressure
Front 15 × 6.00-6, 4PR 200 kPa (2.0 kgf/cm2, 29.0 psi)
Rear 20 × 10.00-8, 4PR 140 kPa (1.4 kgf/cm2, 20.3 psi)

Though the tire pressure is factory-set to the prescribed level, it naturally drops slowly in the course of time.
Thus, check it everyday and inflate as necessary.
9Y1210595GEG0069US0

[2] TREAD
The tread can not be adjusted.
IMPORTANT
• Do not turn discs to obtain wider tread.
• Always attach tires as shown in the drawing.
• If not attached as illustrated, transmission parts may be damaged.
NOTE
• Use the tapered bolts for wheels with beveled or tapered holes.
Front Rear
15 × 6.00 - 6, 4PR 20 × 10.00 - 8, 4PR

A: 750 mm (29.5 in.) B: 800 mm (3.15 in.)


9Y1210595GEG0049US0

G-60

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM GENERAL

10. IMPLEMENT LIMITATIONS


The KUBOTA Tractor has been thoroughly tested for proper performance with implements sold or approved by
KUBOTA. Use with implements which are not sold or approved by KUBOTA and which exceed the maximum
specifications listed below, or which are otherwise unfit for use with the KUBOTA Tractor may result in malfunctions
or failures of the tractor, damage to other property and injury to the operator or others. [Any malfunctions or failures
of the tractor resulting from use with improper implements are not covered by the warranty.]
WSM000001GEG0083US0

MODEL Maximum axle loading weight

GR1600EU, Front axle Wf Rear axle Wr Total gross weight


GR1600F 250 kg (551 lbs) 450 kg (992 lbs) 600 kg (1323 lbs)

MODEL Maximum axle loading weight


Front axle Wf Rear axle Wr Total gross weight
GR1600ID
180 kg (397 lbs) 190 kg (418 lbs) 370 kg (816 lbs)

9Y1210595GEG0070US0

G-61

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


1 ENGINE

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


MECHANISM

CONTENTS

1. ENGINE BODY........................................................................................................................... 1-M1


[1] HALF-FLOATING HEAD COVER ........................................................................................ 1-M1
[2] CLOSED BREATHER .......................................................................................................... 1-M1
2. LUBRICATING SYSTEM............................................................................................................ 1-M2
3. COOLING SYSTEM ................................................................................................................... 1-M3
4. FUEL SYSTEM........................................................................................................................... 1-M4
[1] FUEL LINE ........................................................................................................................... 1-M4

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE

1. ENGINE BODY
[1] HALF-FLOATING HEAD COVER
The rubber packing is fitting in to keep the head
cover 0.5 mm (0.02 in.) or so off the cylinder head. This
arrangement helps reduce noise coming from the
cylinder head.
(1) Cylinder Head Cover (2) Rubber Packing
9Y1210595ENM0006US0

[2] CLOSED BREATHER


Closed breather system has been adopted to
prevent the release of blow-by gas into the atmosphere.
After its oil content is filtered by oil shield (4), the
blow-by gas is fed back to the intake manifold through
breather valve (3) to be used for re-combustion.
(1) Breather Tube (4) Oil Shield
(2) Cylinder Head Cover (5) Rubber Packing
(3) Breather Valve (PCV)
9Y1210595ENM0002US0

1-M1

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE

2. LUBRICATING SYSTEM
(1) Rocker Arm
(2) Oil Pressure Switch
(3) Rocker Arm Shaft
(4) Valve
(5) Idle Gear
(6) Crankshaft
(7) Oil Pump
(8) Oil Strainer
(9) Relief Valve
(10) Push Rod
(11) Tappet
(12) Camshaft
(13) Piston
(14) Connecting Rod
(15) Oil Filter Cartridge

This engine's lubricating system consists of oil strainer (8), oil pump (7), relief valve (9), oil filter cartridge (15) and
oil pressure switch (2).
The oil pump sucks lubricating oil from the oil pan through the oil strainer and the oil flows down to the filter
cartridge, where it is further filtered. Then the oil is forced to crankshaft (6), connecting rods (14), idle gear (5),
camshaft (12) and rocker arm shaft (3) to lubricate each part.
Some part of oil, splashed by the crankshaft or leaking and dropping from gaps of each part, lubricates these
parts: piston (13), cylinders, small ends or connecting rods, tappets (11), push rods (10), inlet and exhaust valves (4)
and timing gears.
9Y1210595ENM0003US0

1-M2

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE

3. COOLING SYSTEM
(1) Radiator
(2) Water Pump
(3) Cooling Fan
(4) Thermostat
(5) Cylinder Head
(6) Cylinder Block

The cooling system consists of a radiator (1), a centrifugal water pump (2), a cooling fan (3) and a thermostat (4).
The coolant is cooled through the radiator core, and the cooling fan (3) set behind the radiator (1) pushes cooling
air through the radiator core to improve cooling.
The water pump receives water from the radiator or from the cylinder head and force it into the cylinder block.
The thermostat opens or closes according to the water temperature. When the water temperature is high, the
thermostat opens to allow the water to flow from the cylinder head to the radiator. When the water temperature is low,
the thermostat close to flow the water only to the water pump.
9Y1210595ENM0004US0

1-M3

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE

4. FUEL SYSTEM
[1] FUEL LINE
(1) Injection Nozzle
(2) Fuel Overflow Pipe
(3) Fuel Tank
(4) Fuel Filter
(5) Fuel Feed Pump
(6) Fuel Filter
(7) Injection Pump
(8) Injection Pipe

Fuel from the fuel tank (3) passes through the fuel filter (4), and then enters the injection pump (7) after impurities
such as dirt, water, etc. are removed.
The fuel pressurized by the injection pump to the opening pressure (13.8 to 14.7 MPa, 140 to 150 kgf/cm2, 2000
to 2130 psi), of the injection nozzle (1) is injected into the combustion chamber.
Part of the fuel fed to the injection nozzle (1) lubricates the moving parts of the needle valve inside the nozzle,
then returns to the fuel tank through the fuel overflow pipe (2) from the upper part of the nozzle holder.
9Y1210595ENM0005US0

1-M4

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


SERVICING

CONTENTS

1. TROUBLESHOOTING.................................................................................................................1-S1
2. SERVICING SPECIFICATIONS ..................................................................................................1-S4
3. TIGHTENING TORQUES............................................................................................................1-S9
4. CHECKING, DISASSEMBLING AND SERVICING ...................................................................1-S10
[1] CHECKING AND ADJUSTING............................................................................................1-S10
(1) Engine Body ..................................................................................................................1-S10
(2) Lubricating System ........................................................................................................1-S13
(3) Cooling System .............................................................................................................1-S14
(4) Fuel System...................................................................................................................1-S16
[2] PREPARATION ...................................................................................................................1-S19
(1) Separation of the Engine ...............................................................................................1-S19
[3] DISASSEMBLING AND ASSEMBLING ..............................................................................1-S22
(1) Cylinder Head and Valves .............................................................................................1-S22
(2) Timing Gear, Camshaft and Fuel Camshaft ..................................................................1-S25
(3) Piston and Connecting Rod...........................................................................................1-S29
(4) Crankshaft .....................................................................................................................1-S32
(5) Water Pump...................................................................................................................1-S35
(6) Injection Nozzle .............................................................................................................1-S35
[4] SERVICING .........................................................................................................................1-S36
(1) Cylinder Head and Valves .............................................................................................1-S36
(2) Timing Gear, Camshaft and Fuel Camshaft ..................................................................1-S41
(3) Piston and Connecting Rod...........................................................................................1-S43
(4) Crankshaft .....................................................................................................................1-S46
(5) Cylinder .........................................................................................................................1-S50
(6) Oil Pump........................................................................................................................1-S50

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE

1. TROUBLESHOOTING
Reference
Symptom Probable Cause Solution
Page
Engine Does Not No fuel Fill fuel G-9
Start Air in the fuel system Bleed G-45
Water in the fuel system Change fuel and G-32
repair or replace fuel
system
Fuel pipe clogged Clean G-32
Fuel filter clogged Change G-32
Excessively high viscosity of fuel or engine oil at Use specified fuel or G-9
low temperature engine oil
Fuel with low cetane number Use specified fuel G-9
Fuel leak due to loose injection pipe retaining nut Tighten retaining nut 1-S23
Incorrect injection timing Adjust 1-S16
Fuel camshaft worn Replace –
Injection nozzle clogged Repair or replace 1-S35
Injection pump malfunctioning Replace 1-S25
Seizure of crankshaft, camshaft, piston, cylinder Repair or replace –
or bearing
Compression leak from cylinder Replace head gasket, 1-S23,
tighten cylinder head 1-S24,
screw, glow plug and 1-S25
nozzle holder
Improper valve timing Correct or replace 1-S27
timing gear
Piston ring and cylinder worn Replace 1-S45,
1-S50
Excessive valve clearance Adjust 1-S12
(Starter Does Not Battery discharged Charge G-29
Run) Starter malfunctioning Repair or replace 6-S22
Main switch malfunctioning Replace 6-S8,
6-S9
Safety switches malfunctioning Replace 6-S11,
6-S12
Wiring disconnected Connect –
Engine Revolution Is Fuel filter clogged or dirty Replace G-32
Not Smooth Air cleaner clogged Clean or replace G-25
Fuel leak due to loose injection pipe retaining nut Tighten retaining nut 1-S23
Injection pump malfunctioning Replace 1-S28
Incorrect nozzle injection pressure Adjust 1-S18
Injection nozzle stuck or clogged Repair or replace 1-S35
Governor malfunctioning Repair –

1-S1

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE

Reference
Symptom Probable Cause Solution
Page
Either White or Blue Excessive engine oil Reduce to specified G-9,
Exhaust Gas Is level G-18
Observed Piston ring and cylinder worn or stuck Repair or replace 1-S45,
1-S50
Incorrect injection timing Adjust 1-S16
Deficient compression Adjust top clearance 1-S11
Either Black or Dark Overload Reduce the load –
Gray Exhaust Gas Is Low grade fuel used Use specified fuel G-9
Observed
Fuel filter clogged Replace G-40
Air cleaner clogged Clean or replace G-25
Deficient nozzle injection Repair or replace 1-S35
nozzle
Deficient Output Incorrect injection timing Adjust 1-S16
Engine's moving parts seem to be seizing Repair or replace –
Uneven fuel injection Replace injection 1-S25
pump
Deficient nozzle injection Repair or replace 1-S35
nozzle
Compression leak Replace head gasket, 1-S23,
tighten cylinder head 1-S24
screw, glow plug and
nozzle holder
Excessive Lubricant Piston ring's gap facing the same direction Shift ring gap 1-S30
Oil Consumption direction
Oil ring worn or stuck Replace 1-S31,
1-S45
Piston ring groove worn Replace piston 1-S31,
1-S45
Valve stem and valve guide worn Replace 1-S25
Oil leaking due to damaged seals or packing Replace –
Fuel Mixed into Injection pump's plunger worn Replace injection 1-S25
Lubricant Oil pump
Deficient nozzle injection Repair or replace 1-S35
nozzle
Injection pump broken Replace 1-S25
Water Mixed into Head gasket damaged Replace 1-S25
Lubricant Oil Cylinder block or cylinder head flawed Replace 1-S24

1-S2

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE

Reference
Symptom Probable Cause Solution
Page
Low Oil Pressure Engine oil insufficient Fill G-9,
G-18
Oil strainer clogged Clean –
Oil filter clogged Replace G-35
Relief valve stuck with dirt Clean –
Relief valve spring weaken or broken Replace –
Excessive oil clearance of crankshaft bearing Replace 1-S48,
1-S49
Excessive oil clearance of crankpin bearing Replace 1-S47
Excessive oil clearance of rocker arm Replace 1-S40
Oil passage clogged Clean –
Different type of oil Use specified type of G-9
oil
Oil pump damaged Repair or replace 1-S28
High Oil Pressure Different type of oil Use specified type of G-9
oil
Relief valve damaged Replace –
Engine Overheated Engine oil insufficient Fill G-9
Fan belt broken or tensioned improperly Replace or adjust G-34
Coolant insufficient Fill G-9
Radiator net and radiator fin clogged with dust Clean –
Inside of radiator corroded Clean or replace G-41
Coolant flow route corroded Clean or replace G-41
Radiator cap damaged Replace 1-S15
Radiator hose damaged Replace G-37
Overload running Reduce the load –
Head gasket damaged Replace 1-S24
Incorrect injection timing Adjust 1-S16
Unsuitable fuel used Use specified fuel G-9
9Y1210595ENS0092US0

1-S3

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE

2. SERVICING SPECIFICATIONS
ENGINE BODY
Item Factory Specification Allowable Limit
Compression Pressure 2.85 to 3.23 MPa 2.26 MPa
29.0 to 33.0 kgf/cm2 23.0 kgf/cm2
413 to 469 psi 327 psi

• Variance Among Cylinder – 10 % or less


Top Clearance 0.50 to 0.70 mm –
0.020 to 0.027 in.
Valve Clearance (Cold) 0.145 to 0.185 mm –
0.00571 to 0.00728 in.
Cylinder Head Surface Flatness – 0.05 mm
0.002 in.
Valve Recessing (Intake and Exhaust) −0.10 to 0.10 mm 0.30 mm
−0.0039 to 0.0039 in. 0.012 in.
Valve Stem to Valve Guide Clearance 0.030 to 0.057 mm 0.10 mm
0.0012 to 0.0022 in. 0.0039 in.

• Valve Stem O.D. 5.968 to 5.980 mm –


0.2350 to 0.2354 in.

• Valve Guide I.D. 6.010 to 6.025 mm –


0.2367 to 0.2372 in.
Valve Seat Width 2.12 mm –
0.0835 in.

Angle 0.79 rad –


45 °
Valve Face Angle 0.79 rad –
45 °
Valve Spring Free Length 31.3 to 31.8 mm 28.4 mm
1.24 to 1.25 in. 1.12 in.

Tilt – 1.2 mm
0.047 in.

Setting Load 65 N 55 N
6.6 kgf 5.6 kgf
15 lbs 12 lbs

Setting Length 27.0 mm –


1.06 in.
Rocker Arm to Rocker Arm Shaft Oil Clearance 0.016 to 0.045 mm 0.15 mm
0.00063 to 0.0017 in. 0.0059 in.

• Rocker Arm Shaft O.D. 10.473 to 10.484 mm –


0.41233 to 0.41275 in.

• Rocker Arm I.D. 10.500 to 10.518 mm –


0.41339 to 0.41409 in.
Push Rod Alignment – 0.25 mm
0.0098 in.

1-S4

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE

Item Factory Specification Allowable Limit


Tappet to Tappet Guide Oil Clearance 0.016 to 0.052 mm 0.10 mm
0.00063 to 0.0020 in. 0.0039 in.

• Tappet O.D. 17.966 to 17.984 mm –


0.70733 to 0.70803 in.

• Tappet Guide Bore I.D. 18.000 to 18.018 mm –


0.70866 to 0.70937 in.
Timing Gear
• Idle Gear to Crank Gear Backlash 0.0430 to 0.124 mm 0.15 mm
0.00170 to 0.00488 in. 0.0059 in.

• Idle Gear to Cam Gear Backlash 0.0470 to 0.123 mm 0.15 mm


0.00185 to 0.00484 in. 0.0059 in.

• Idle Gear to Injection Pump Gear Backlash 0.0460 to 0.124 mm 0.15 mm


0.00182 to 0.00488 in. 0.0059 in.

• Oil Pump Drive Gear to Crank Gear Backlash 0.0410 to 0.123 mm 0.15 mm
0.00162 to 0.00484 in. 0.0059 in.
Idle Gear Side Clearance 0.20 to 0.51 mm 0.80 mm
0.0079 to 0.020 in. 0.031 in.
Camshaft Side Clearance 0.15 to 0.31 mm 0.50 mm
0.0059 to 0.012 in. 0.020 in.

Alignment – 0.01 mm
0.0004 in.

Cam Height 26.88 mm 26.83 mm


(Intake and 1.058 in. 1.056 in.
Exhaust)
Camshaft Journal to Cylinder Block Bore Oil Clearance 0.050 to 0.091 mm 0.15 mm
0.0020 to 0.0035 in. 0.0059 in.

• Camshaft Journal O.D. 32.934 to 32.950 mm –


1.2967 to 1.2972 in.

• Cylinder Block Bore I.D. 33.000 to 33.025 mm –


1.2993 to 1.3001 in.
Idle Gear Shaft to Idle Gear Bushing Oil Clearance 0.020 to 0.084 mm 0.10 mm
0.00079 to 0.0033 in. 0.0039 in.

• Idle Gear Shaft O.D. 19.967 to 19.980 mm –


0.78611 to 0.78661 in.

• Idle Gear Bushing I.D. 20.000 to 20.051 mm –


0.78741 to 0.78940 in.
Piston Pin Bore I.D. 20.000 to 20.013 mm 20.05 mm
0.78741 to 0.78791 in. 0.7894 in.

1-S5

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE

Item Factory Specification Allowable Limit


Piston Pin to Small End Bushing Oil Clearance 0.014 to 0.038 mm 0.10 mm
0.00056 to 0.0014 in. 0.0039 in.

• Piston Pin O.D. 20.002 to 20.011 mm –


0.78748 to 0.78783 in.

• Small End Bushing I.D. 20.025 to 20.040 mm –


0.78839 to 0.78897 in.
Piston Pin to Small End Bushing Oil Clearance 0.015 to 0.075 mm 0.15 mm
(Spare Parts) 0.00059 to 0.0029 in. 0.0059 in.

• Small End Bushing I.D. 20.026 to 20.077 mm –


0.78843 to 0.79043 in.
Piston Ring Gap
• Top Ring 0.15 to 0.30 mm 1.20 mm
0.0059 to 0.011 in. 0.0472 in.

• Second Ring 0.3 to 0.40 mm 1.20 mm


0.012 to 0.015 in. 0.0472 in.

• Oil Ring 0.15 to 0.30 mm 1.20 mm


0.0059 to 0.011 in. 0.0472 in.
Piston Ring to Piston Ring Groove
• Second Ring Clearance 0.0850 to 0.115 mm 0.15 mm
0.00335 to 0.00452 in. 0.0059 in.

• Oil Ring Clearance 0.02 to 0.06 mm 0.15 mm


0.0008 to 0.002 in. 0.0059 in.
Connecting Rod Alignment – 0.05 mm
0.0020 in.
Crankshaft Side Clearance 0.15 to 0.30 mm 0.50 mm
0.0059 to 0.011 in. 0.0197 in.

Alignment – 0.02 mm
0.0008 in.
Crankpin to Crankpin Bearing Oil Clearance 0.020 to 0.051 mm 0.15 mm
0.00079 to 0.0020 in. 0.0059 in.

• Crankpin O.D. 33.959 to 33.975 mm –


1.3370 to 1.3375 in.

• Crankpin Bearing I.D. 33.995 to 34.010 mm –


1.3384 to 1.3389 in.
Crankshaft Journal to Crankshaft Bearing 1 Oil Clearance 0.0340 to 0.106 mm 0.20 mm
0.00134 to 0.00417 in. 0.0079 in.

• Crankshaft Journal O.D. 39.934 to 39.950 mm –


1.5722 to 1.5728 in.

• Crankshaft Bearing 1 I.D. 39.984 to 40.040 mm –


1.5742 to 1.5763 in.

1-S6

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE

Item Factory Specification Allowable Limit


Crankshaft Journal to Crankshaft Bearing 2 Oil Clearance 0.028 to 0.051 mm 0.20 mm
(Flywheel Side) 0.0011 to 0.0020 in. 0.0079 in.

• Crankshaft Journal O.D. 43.934 to 43.950 mm –


1.7297 to 1.7303 in.

• Crankshaft Bearing 2 I.D. 43.984 to 44.026 mm –


1.7317 to 1.7333 in.
Crankshaft Journal to Crankshaft Bearing 3 Oil Clearance 0.028 to 0.051 mm 0.20 mm
(Intermediate) 0.0011 to 0.0020 in. 0.0079 in.

• Crankshaft Journal O.D. 39.934 to 39.950 mm –


1.5722 to 1.5728 in.

• Crankshaft Bearing 3 I.D. 39.984 to 40.026 mm –


1.5742 to 1.5758 in.
Cylinder Liner I.D. 67.000 to 67.019 mm 67.169 mm
2.6378 to 2.6385 in. 2.6444 in.
Cylinder Liner (Oversize) I.D. 67.250 to 67.269 mm 67.419 mm
2.6477 to 2.6483 in. 2.6543 in.
LUBRICATING SYSTEM
Item Factory Specification Allowable Limit
Engine Oil Pressure At Idle Speed More than –
50 kPa
0.5 kgf/cm2
7 psi

At Rated Speed 200 to 440 kPa 150 kPa


2.0 to 4.5 kgf/cm2 1.5 kgf/cm2
29 to 64 psi 21 psi
Oil Pump
• Inter Rotor to Outer Rotor Clearance 0.030 to 0.14 mm –
0.0012 to 0.0055 in.

• Outer Rotor to Pump Body O.D. 0.070 to 0.15 mm –


0.0028 to 0.0059 in.

• Inter Rotor to Cover I.D. 0.075 to 0.135 mm –


0.00296 to 0.00531 in.

1-S7

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE
COOLING SYSTEM
Item Factory Specification Allowable Limit
Fan Belt Tension 7.0 to 9.0 mm / 98 N –
0.28 to 0.35 in. / 98 N
(10 kgf, 22 lbs)
Thermostat Valve Opening 80.5 to 83.5 °C –
Temperature 176.9 to 182.3 °F
(At Beginning)

Valve Opening 95 °C –
Temperature 203 °F
(Opened
Completely)
Radiator Cap Pressure Falling 10 seconds or more –
Time 80 → 60 kPa
0.9 → 0.6 kgf/cm2
10 → 9 psi
Radiator Water Leakage No leak at specified –
Test Pressure pressure
160 kPa
1.6 kgf/cm2
23 psi

FUEL SYSTEM
Item Factory Specification Allowable Limit
Injection Pump Injection Timing 0.32 to 0.34 rad –
(18 to 20 °)
before T.D.C.
Pump Element Fuel Tightness – 13.7 MPa
140 kgf/cm2
1990 psi
Delivery Valve Fuel Tightness 10 seconds 5 seconds
13.7 → 12.8 MPa 13.7 → 12.8 MPa
140 →130 kgf/cm2 140 →130 kgf/cm2
1990 → 1850 psi 1990 → 1850 psi
Fuel Injection Nozzle Injection Pressure 13.8 to 14.7 MPa –
140 to 150 kgf/cm2
2000 to 2130 psi

Valve Seat When the pressure is –


Tightness 12.7 MPa
(130 kgf/cm2, 1850 psi),
the valve seat must be
fuel tightness.
9Y1210595ENS0002US0

1-S8

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE

3. TIGHTENING TORQUES
Tightening torques of screws and nuts on the table below are especially specified.
(For general use screws and nuts: Refer to "5. TIGHTENING TORQUES" on page G-12.)
Dimension ×
Item N·m kgf·m lbf·ft
Pitch
Front coupling mounting screw M8 × 1.25 24 to 27 2.4 to 2.8 18 to 20
Engine mounting nut M8 × 1.25 24 2.4 18
Air cleaner stay screw M8 × 1.25 24 to 27 2.4 to 2.8 18 to 20
Engine support screw M10 × 1.25 48 to 55 4.9 to 5.7 36 to 41
*Cylinder head cover screw M6 × 1.0 6.87 to 11.2 0.700 to 1.15 5.07 to 8.31
Injection pipe retaining nut M12 × 1.5 25 to 34 2.5 to 3.5 18 to 25
Overflow pipe retaining nut M12 × 1.5 20 to 24 2.0 to 2.5 15 to 18
Nozzle holder assembly M20 × 1.5 49 to 68 5.0 to 7.0 37 to 50
Glow plug M8 × 1.0 7.9 to 14 0.80 to 1.5 5.8 to 10
*Rocker arm bracket screw M6 × 1.0 9.81 to 11.2 1.00 to 1.15 7.24 to 8.31
*Cylinder head screw M8 × 1.25 38 to 42 3.8 to 4.3 28 to 31
*Fan drive pulley screw M12 × 1.5 98 to 107 10.0 to 11.0 72.4 to 79.5
*Idle gear shaft mounting screw M6 × 1.0 9.81 to 11.2 1.00 to 1.15 7.24 to 8.31
*Connecting rod screw M7 × 0.75 27 to 30 2.7 to 3.1 20 to 22
*Flywheel screw M10 × 1.25 54 to 58 5.5 to 6.0 40 to 43
Bearing case cover mounting screw M6 × 1.0 9.81 to 11.2 1.00 to 1.15 7.24 to 8.31
*Main bearing case screw 2 M7 × 1.0 27 to 30 2.7 to 3.1 20 to 22
*Main bearing case screw 1 M6 × 1.0 13 to 15 1.3 to 1.6 9.4 to 11
Nozzle holder 35 to 39 3.5 to 4.0 26 to 28
Oil pressure switch PT1/8 15 to 19 1.5 to 2.0 11 to 14
NOTE
• In removing and applying the screws and nuts marked with "*", a pneumatic wrench or similar pneumatic
tool, if employed, must be used with enough care not to get them seized.
• For "*" marked screws and nuts on the table, apply engine oil to their threads and seats before tightening.
• The letter "M" in Size ' Pitch means that the screw or nut dimension stands for metric. The size is the
nominal outside diameter in mm of the threads. The pitch is the nominal distance in mm between two
threads.
9Y1210595ENS0003US0

1-S9

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE

4. CHECKING, DISASSEMBLING AND SERVICING


[1] CHECKING AND ADJUSTING
(1) Engine Body
Compression Pressure
1. Run the engine until it is warmed up.
2. Stop the engine.
3. Disconnect the 2P connector from the fuel pump.
4. Remove the air cleaner, the muffler and all injection nozzles.
5. Disconnect the accelerator wire.
6. Engage the parking brake.
7. Set a compression tester (Code No. 07909-30208) with the
adaptor (Adaptor H, Code No. 07909-31231) to the nozzle hole.
8. While cranking the engine with the starter, measure the
compression pressure.
9. Repeat steps 7 and 8 for each cylinder.
10. If the measurement is below the allowable limit, apply a small
amount of oil to the cylinder wall through the nozzle hole and
measure the compression pressure again.
11. If the compression pressure is still less than the allowable limit,
check the top clearance, valve clearance and cylinder head.
12. If the compression pressure increases after applying oil, check
the cylinder wall and piston rings.
NOTE
• Check the compression pressure with the specified valve
clearance.
• Always use a fully charged battery for performing this test.
• Variances in cylinder compression values should be under
10 %.
2.85 to 3.23 MPa
Factory specification 29.0 to 33.0 kgf/cm2
413 to 469 psi
Compression pressure
2.26 MPa
Allowable limit 23.0 kgf/cm2
327 psi
9Y1210595ENS0004US0

1-S10

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE
Top Clearance
1. Remove the cylinder head. (Do not try to remove the cylinder
head gasket.)
2. Move the piston up, and stick a strip of plastigauge (1) [5.0 to
7.0 mm long (0.20 to 0.27 in. long)] on the piston head at three
positions with grease so as to avoid the intake and exhaust
valves and the combustion chamber ports.
3. Lower the piston, and install the cylinder head and tighten the
cylinder head screws to the specified torque.
4. Turn the flywheel until the piston exceeds its top dead center.
5. Remove the cylinder head, and measure the squeezed
plastigauges (2).
6. If the measurement is not within the factory specifications,
check the oil clearance between the crankpin and crankpin
bearing and between the piston pin and small end bushing.
NOTE
• After checking the top clearance, be sure to assemble the
cylinder head with a new cylinder head gasket.
0.50 to 0.70 mm
Top clearance Factory specification
0.020 to 0.027 in.

38 to 42 N·m
Tightening torque Cylinder head screw 3.8 to 4.3 kgf·m
28 to 31 lbf·ft

(1) Plastigauge (3) Scale


(2) Squeezed Plastigauge
9Y1210595ENS0091US0

1-S11

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE
Valve Clearance
IMPORTANT
• The valve clearance must be checked and adjusted when
engine is cold.
1. Remove the cylinder head cover (1) and the glow plugs.
Remove the flywheel cover (4). [GR1600F, GR1600ID only]
2. Align the "1TC" mark (2) on the flywheel and alignment mark (3)
on the rear end plate so that the No. 1 piston comes to the
compression top dead center.
3. Check the following valve clearance marked with "" using a
thickness gauge.
[When No.1 piston is at the compression top dead center
position]
Cylinder No. No. 1 No. 2
Intake valve 
Exhaust valve  

4. If the clearance is not within the factory specifications, adjust


with the adjusting screw.
5. Then turn the flywheel 6.28 rad (360 °), and align the "1TC"
mark (2) on the flywheel and alignment mark (3) on the rear end
plate so that the No. 1 piston comes to the overlap position.
6. Check the following valve clearance marked with "" using a
thickness gauge.
[When No. 1 piston is at the overlap position]
Cylinder No. No. 1 No. 2
Intake valve 
Exhaust valve

7. If the clearance is not within the factory specifications, adjust


with the adjusting screw.
Intake and exhaust valve 0.145 to 0.185 mm
Factory specification
clearance (Cold) 0.00571 to 0.00728 in.

NOTE
• The sequence of cylinder numbers is given as No. 1 and
No. 2 starting from the gear case side.
• After adjusting the valve clearance, secure the adjusting
screw with the lock nut.
(1) Cylinder Head Cover A: Gear Case Side
(2) "1TC" Mark
(3) Alignment Mark
(4) Flywheel Cover
9Y1210595ENS0006US0

1-S12

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE

(2) Lubricating System


Engine Oil Pressure
1. Remove the engine oil pressure switch, and set an oil pressure
tester (Code No.: 07916-32032).
2. Start the engine. After warming up, measure the oil pressure of
both idling and rated speeds.
3. If the oil pressure is less than the allowable limit, check the
following.
• Engine oil insufficient
• Oil pump damaged
• Oil strainer clogged
• Oil filter cartridge clogged
• Oil gallery clogged
• Excessive oil clearance
• Foreign matter in the relief valve
More than
Factory
At idle 50 kPa
specifica-
speed 0.5 kgf/cm2
tion
7 psi
Factory 200 to 440 kPa
Engine oil pressure
specifica- 2.0 to 4.5 kgf/cm2
At rated tion 29 to 64 psi
speed 150 kPa
Allowable
1.5 kgf/cm2
limit
21 psi

(When reassembling)
• After checking the engine oil pressure, tighten the engine oil
pressure switch to the specified torque.
9Y1210595ENS0007US0

1-S13

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE

(3) Cooling System


Checking Fan Drive Belt Tension

CAUTION
To avoid personal injury:
• Be sure to stop the engine and remove the key before
checking belt tension.
IMPORTANT
• When replacing the fan drive belt, be careful not to catch it
on the cap under the water pump.
1. Measure the deflection "A", depressing the belt halfway
between the fan drive pulley (1) and dynamo pulley (2) at
specified force (98 N, 10 kgf, 22 lbs).
2. If the measurement is not within the factory specifications,
loosen the dynamo mounting screws (3) and relocate the
dynamo to adjust.
10 mm
Deflection "A" Factory specification
0.39 in.

(1) Fan Drive Pulley A: Approx. 10 mm (0.39 in.)


(2) Dynamo Pulley M: "MOVE"
(3) Dynamo Mounting Screw X: Incorrect Belt Pass
9Y1210595GEG0023US0

Fan Belt Damage and Wear


1. Check the fan belt for damage.
2. If the fan belt is damaged, replace it.
3. Check if the fan belt is worn and sunk in the pulley groove.
4. If the fan belt is nearly worn out and deeply sunk in the pulley
groove, replace it.
(A) Good (B) Bad
9Y1210595ENS0009US0

1-S14

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE
Thermostat Valve Opening Temperature
1. Suspend the thermostat in the water by a string with its end
inserted between the valve and seat.
2. Heating the water gradually, read the temperature when the
valve opens and leaves the string.
3. Continue heating and read the temperature when the valve
opens approx. 6 mm (0.2 in.).
4. If the measurement is not within the factory specifications,
replace the thermostat.
Thermostat's valve 80.5 to 83.5 °C
Factory specification
opening temperature 176.9 to 182.3 °F
Temperature at which
95 °C
thermostat completely Factory specification
203 °F
opens
9Y1210595ENS0010US0

CAUTION
• When removing the radiator cap, wait at least ten minutes after the engine has stopped and cooled down.
Otherwise, hot water may gush out, scalding nearby people.
9Y1210595ENS0011US0
Radiator Cap Air Leakage
1. Set a radiator tester (1) and an adaptor (2) (BANZAI Code No.:
RCT-2A-30S) on the radiator cap.
2. Apply the specified pressure (80 kPa, 0.9 kgf/cm2, 10 psi), and
measure the time for the pressure to fall to 60 kPa (0.6 kgf/cm2,
9 psi).
3. If the measurement is less than the factory specification,
replace the radiator cap.
More than
10 seconds for pressure
fall from
Pressure falling time Factory specification
80 to 60 kPa
(from 0.9 to 0.6 kgf/cm2,
from 10 to 9 psi)

(1) Radiator Tester (2) Adapter


9Y1210595ENS0012US0
Radiator Water Leakage
1. Pour a specified amount of water into the radiator.
2. Set a radiator tester (1) (Code No. 07909-31551) and an
adapter (2) (BANZAI Code No.: RCT-2A-30S) and raise the
water pressure to the specified pressure.
3. Check the radiator for water leaks.
4. For water leak from the pinhole, repair with the radiator
cement.When water leak is excessive, replace the radiator.
160 kPa
Radiator water leakage
Factory specification 1.6 kgf/cm2
test pressure
23 psi

(1) Radiator Tester (2) Adapter


9Y1210595ENS0013US0

1-S15

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE

(4) Fuel System


Injection Timing
1. Remove the injection pipes.
2. Remove the engine stop solenoid.
3. Turn the flywheel counterclockwise (facing the flywheel) until
fuel flows from the delivery valve holder.
4. Continue to turn the flywheel slowly, and stop it as soon as the
fuel level at the tip of the delivery valve holder begins to
increase.
5. Check to see if the timing angle lines on the flywheel is aligned
with the alignment mark (2).
6. If the injection timing is out of adjustment, readjust the timing
with shims.
0.32 to 0.34 rad
Injection timing Factory specification
(18 to 20 °) before T.D.C.

NOTE
• The sealant is applied to both sides of the shims (soft metal
gasket shim). The liquid gasket is not required for
assembling.
• Shims are available in thickness of 0.20 mm (0.0079 in.),
0.25 mm (0.0098 in.) and 0.30 mm (0.012 in.). Combine these
shims for adjustments.
• Addition or reduction of shim (0.05 mm, 0.002 in.) delays or
advances the injection timing by approx. 0.009 rad. (0.5 °).
• In disassembling and replacing the injection pump, be sure
to use the same number of new shims with the same
thickness.
• Refer to figure below to check the thickness of the shims.
(1) Timing Line (4) Two-holes: 0.20 mm (0.0079 in.)
(2) Alignment Mark (5) One-hole: 0.25 mm (0.0098 in.)
(3) Shim (Soft Metal Gasket Shim) (6) Without hole: 0.30 mm (0.012 in.)
9Y1210595ENS0014US0
Fuel Tightness of Pump Element
1. Remove the engine stop solenoid.
2. Remove the injection pipes and glow plugs.
3. Install the injection pump pressure tester to the injection pump.
4. Install the injection nozzle (1) jetted with the proper injection
pressure to the injection pump pressure tester (2). (Refer to the
figure.)
5. Set the speed control lever to the maximum speed position.
6. Run the starter to increase the pressure.
7. If the pressure can not reach the allowable limit, replace the
pump with new one or repair with a KUBOTA-authorized pump
service shop.
13.7 MPa
Fuel tightness of pump
Factory specification 140 kgf/cm2
element
1990 psi

NOTE
• Never try to disassemble the injection pump assembly. For
repairs, you are strongly requested to contact a
KUBOTA-authorized pump service shop.
(1) Injection Nozzle (3) Protection Cover for Jetted Fuel
(2) Injection Pump Pressure Tester
9Y1210595ENS0015US0

1-S16

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE
Fuel Tightness of Delivery Valve
1. Remove the engine stop solenoid.
2. Remove the injection pipes and glow plugs.
3. Set a pressure tester to the fuel injection pump.
4. Install the injection nozzle (1) jetted with the proper injection
pressure to the injection pump pressure tester (2).
5. Run the starter to increase the pressure.
6. Stop the starter when the fuel jets from the injection nozzle.
After that, turn the flywheel by hand and raise the pressure to
approx. 13.7 MPa (140 kgf/cm2, 1990 psi).
7. Now turn the flywheel back about half a turn (to keep the plunger
free). Keep the flywheel at this position and clock the time taken
for the pressure to drop from 13.7 to 12.8 MPa (from 140 to 130
kgf/cm2, from 1990 to 1850 psi).
8. Measure the time needed to decrease the pressure from 13.7 to
12.8 MPa (from 140 to 130 kgf/cm2, 1990 to 1850 psi).
9. If the measurement is less than allowable limit, replace the
pump with new one or repair with a KUBOTA-authorized pump
service shop.
10 seconds
13.7 → 12.8 MPa
Factory specification
140 → 130 kgf/cm2
Fuel tightness of delivery 1990 → 1850 psi
valve 5 seconds
13.7 → 12.8 MPa
Allowable limit
140 → 130 kgf/cm2
1990 → 1850 psi

NOTE
• Never try to disassemble the injection pump assembly. For
repairs, you are strongly requested to contact a
KUBOTA-authorized pump service shop.
(1) Injection Nozzle (3) Protection Cover for Jetted Fuel
(2) Injection Pump Pressure Tester
9Y1210595ENS0093US0

CAUTION
• Check the injection pressure and condition after you make sure that there is nobody standing in the
direction the fume goes.
• If the fume from the nozzle directly contacts the human body, cells may be destroyed and blood
poisoning may be caused.
9Y1210595ENS0094US0
Nozzle Spraying Condition
1. Set the injection nozzle to a nozzle tester (Code
No. 07909-31361), and check the nozzle spraying condition.
2. If the spraying condition is damaged, replace the nozzle piece.
(a) Good (b) Bad
9Y1210595ENS0018US0

1-S17

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE
Fuel Injection Pressure
1. Set the injection nozzle to a nozzle tester (Code
No. 07909-31361).
2. Slowly move the tester handle to measure the pressure at which
fuel begins jetting out from the nozzle.
3. If the measurement is not within the factory specifications,
replace the adjusting washer (1) in the nozzle holder to adjust it.
13.7 to 14.7 MPa
Fuel injection pressure Factory specification 140 to 150 kgf/cm2
2000 to 2130 psi

(Reference)
• Pressure variation with 0.01 mm (0.0004 in.) difference of
adjusting washer thickness.
Approx. 240 kPa (2.4 kgf/cm2, 34 psi)
(1) Adjusting Washer
9Y1210595ENS0019US0

Valve Seat Tightness


1. Set the injection nozzle to a nozzle tester (Code No.
07909-31361).
2. Raise the fuel pressure, and keep at 12.8 MPa (130 kgf/cm2,
1850 psi) for 10 seconds.
3. If any fuel leak is found, replace the nozzle piece.
No fuel leak at
12.8 MPa
Valve seat tightness Factory specification
130 kgf/cm2
1850 psi
9Y1210595ENS0020US0

1-S18

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE

[2] PREPARATION
(1) Separation of the Engine
Draining Coolant

CAUTION
• Never open the radiator cap while operating or immediately
after stopping. Otherwise, hot water will spout out from the
radiator. Wait for more than ten minutes to cool the
radiator, before opening the cap.
1. Open the radiator drain plug (2), and remove radiator cap (1) to
completely drain the coolant.
2. After all coolant is drained, close the drain plug (2).
2.35 L
Capacity (with
Coolant 2.48 U.S.qts
recovery tank)
2.07 lmp.qts

(1) Radiator Cap (2) Drain Plug


9Y1210595ENS0021US0

Draining Engine Oil


1. Start and warm up the engine for approx. 5 minutes.
2. Place an oil pan underneath the engine.
3. Remove the drain plug (1) to drain oil.
4. After draining, screw in the drain plug (1).
(When refilling)
• Fill the engine oil up to the upper line on the dipstick (3).
IMPORTANT
• Never mix two different type of oil.
• Use the proper SAE Engine Oil according to ambient
temperature. Refer to "4. LUBRICANTS, FUEL AND
COOLANT" on page G-9.
1.2 L
Engine Oil Capacity 1.3 U.S.qts
1.1 lmp.qts

(1) Drain Plug A: Upper Level


(2) Oil Inlet B: Lower Level
(3) Dipstick
9Y1210595ENS0022US0

1-S19

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE
Battery

CAUTION
• When disconnecting the battery cables, disconnect the
negative cable from the battery first. When connecting,
connect the positive cable to the battery first.
1. Open the bonnet.
2. Disconnect the negative cable (1) from the battery.
3. Disconnect the positive cable (2) from the battery and remove
the battery (3).
(1) Negative Cable (3) Battery
(2) Positive Cable
9Y1210595ENS0023US0
Bonnet and Side Bonnet
1. Disconnect the connectors (5) from the head light.
2. Remove the wire harness (4) from the bonnet.
3. Remove the bonnet (1) with bonnet bracket (2).
4. Remove the side bonnet (3).
(1) Bonnet (4) Wire Harness
(2) Bonnet Bracket (5) Connector
(3) Side Bonnet
9Y1210595ENS0024US0

1-S20

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE
Air Cleaner, Muffler, Fuel Hose and Wire Harness
1. Remove the air cleaner (1) and muffler (2).
2. Disconnect the fuel hoses (3).
3. Disconnect the accelerator wire (4).
4. Disconnect the wire harness (5).
5. Remove the flywheel cover (6). [GR1600F, GR1600ID only]
(1) Air Cleaner (4) Accelerator Wire
(2) Muffler (5) Wire Harness
(3) Fuel Hose (6) Flywheel Cover
9Y1210595ENS0025US0

1-S21

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE
Engine Assembly
1. Remove the radiator retaining snap pins (1).
2. Disconnect the front coupling (2).
3. Separate the engine assembly (3) with radiator from the frame
(4).
(When reassembling)
24 to 27 N·m
Front coupling mounting
2.4 to 2.8 kgf·m
screw
18 to 20 lbf·ft
Tightening torque
24 N·m
Engine mounting nut 2.4 kgf·m
18 lbf·ft

(1) Radiator Retaining Snap Pin (3) Engine Assembly


(2) Front Coupling (4) Frame
9Y1210595ENS0026US0

[3] DISASSEMBLING AND ASSEMBLING


(1) Cylinder Head and Valves
Dynamo, Fan Belt and Radiator
1. Disconnect the radiator hoses and separate the radiator (1) with
recovery tank (2) from engine assembly.
2. Remove the cooling fan (9) and can pulley.
3. Remove the dynamo (3) and fan belt (4).
4. Remove the starter (6).
5. Disconnect the air cleaner stay (8) and engine stop solenoid.
6. Remove the wire bracket.
7. Remove the engine support LH (7) and RH (5).
(When reassembling)
• Check to see that there are no cracks on the belt surface.
IMPORTANT
• After reassembling the fan belt, be sure to adjust the fan
belt tension.
24 to 27 N·m
Air cleaner stay screw 2.4 to 2.8 kgf·m
18 to 20 lbf·ft
Tightening torque
48 to 55 N·m
Engine support screw 4.9 to 5.7 kgf·m
36 to 41 lbf·ft

(1) Radiator (6) Starter


(2) Recovery Tank (7) Engine Support LH
(3) Dynamo (8) Air Cleaner Stay
(4) Fan Belt (9) Cooling Fan
(5) Engine Support RH
9Y1210595ENS0027US0

1-S22

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE
Cylinder Head Cover
1. Remove the head cover screws (1).
2. Remove the cylinder head cover (2).
(When reassembling)
• Check to see if the cylinder head cover gasket is not damaged.
6.87 to 11.2 N·m
Tightening torque Cylinder head cover screw 0.78 to 1.15 kgf·m
5.07 to 8.31 lbf·ft

(1) Head Cover Screws (2) Cylinder Head Cover


9Y1210595ENS0028US0
Injection Pipes
1. Loosen the screw on the pipe clamp (1).
2. Remove the injection pipes (2).
(When reassembling)
• Sent compressed air into pipes to blow out dust. Then,
reassemble the pipes in the reverse order.
25 to 34 N·m
Tightening torque Injection pipe retaining nut 2.5 to 3.5 kgf·m
18 to 25 lbf·ft

(1) Pipe Clamp (2) Injection Pipe


9Y1210595ENS0095US0
Nozzle Holder Assembly and Glow Plug
1. Remove the overflow pipe (1).
2. Remove the nozzle holder assemblies (2).
3. Remove the copper gasket (5) and the heat seal (6).
4. Remove the lead (3) from the glow plugs (4).
5. Remove the glow plugs (4).
(When reassembling)
• Replace the copper gasket and heat seal with new one.
20 to 24 N·m
Overflow pipe retaining nut 2.0 to 2.5 kgf·m
15 to 18 lbf·ft
49 to 68 N·m
Tightening torque Nozzle holder assembly 5.0 to 7.0 kgf·m
37 to 50 lbf·ft
7.9 to 14 N·m
Glow plug 0.8 to 1.5 kgf·m
5.8 to 10 lbf·ft

(1) Overflow Pipe (4) Glow Plug


(2) Nozzle Holder Assembly (5) Copper Gasket
(3) Lead (6) Heat Seal
9Y1210595ENS0030US0

1-S23

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE
Rocker Arm and Push Rod
1. Remove the rocker arm bracket screws (1).
2. Remove the rocker arm assembly (2).
3. Remove the push rods (3).
(When reassembling)
• When putting the push rods (3) onto the tappets (4), check to
see if their ends are properly engaged with the dimples.
IMPORTANT
• After installing the rocker arm, be sure to adjust the valve
clearance.
9.81 to 11.2 N·m
Tightening torque Rocker arm bracket screw 1.00 to 1.15 kgf·m
7.24 to 8.31 lbf·ft

(1) Rocker Arm Bracket Screws (3) Push Rod


(2) Rocker Arm Assembly (4) Tappet
9Y1210595ENS0031US0

Cylinder Head
1. Loosen the pipe clamp, and remove the water return pipe.
2. Remove the cylinder head screw in the order of "j" to "a".
3. Lift up the cylinder head to remove.
4. Remove the cylinder head gasket and O-ring (1).
(When reassembling)
• Replace the cylinder head gasket with a new one.
• Securely fit the O-ring (1) to the pipe pin.
• Tighten the cylinder head screws after applying sufficient oil.
• Tighten the cylinder head screws diagonal sequence starting
from the centre.
• Tighten them uniformly, or the head may deform in the long run.
• Retighten the cylinder head screws after running the engine for
30 minutes.
38 to 42 N·m
Tightening torque Cylinder head screw 3.8 to 4.3 kgf·m
28 to 31 lbf·ft

(1) O-ring j to a: To Loosen


a to j: To Tighten
9Y1210595ENS0096US0

Tappets
1. Remove the tappets (1) from the crankcase.
(When reassembling)
• Visually check the contact between tappets and cams for proper
rotation. If problem is found, replace tappets.
• Before installing the tappets, apply engine oil thinly around
them.
IMPORTANT
• Do not change the combination of tappet and tappet guide.
(1) Tappet
9Y1210595ENS0097US0

1-S24

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE
Valves
1. Remove the valve caps (2).
2. Remove the valve spring collet (3), pushing the valve spring
retainer (4) by valve spring replacer (1).
3. Remove the valve spring retainer (4), valve spring (5) and valve
stem seal (6).
4. Remove the valve (7).
(When reassembling)
• Wash the valve stem seal and valve guide hole, and apply
engine oil sufficiently.
• After installing the valve spring collets, lightly tap the stem to
assure proper fit with a plastic hammer.
IMPORTANT
• Do not change the combination of valve and valve guide.
(1) Valve Spring Replacer (5) Valve Spring
(2) Valve Cap (6) Valve Stem Seal
(3) Valve Spring Collet (7) Valve
(4) Valve Spring Retainer
9Y1210595ENS0034US0

(2) Timing Gear, Camshaft and Fuel Camshaft


Injection Pump and Speed Control Plate
1. Remove the socket head screws and nuts, and remove the
injection pump (3).
2. Remove the screws and separate the speed control plate (2).
Be careful not to damage the governor spring (4).
3. Disconnect the governor spring (4) and remove the speed
control plate (2).
(When reassembling)
• Hook the governor spring (4) to the governor lever (5) first and
install the speed control plate (2).
• Be sure to place the copper washers underneath two screws
(1). (Two screws (1) in the upper of the speed control plate (2).)
• Position the slot (9) on the fork lever just under the slot (8) on
the crankcase.
• Insert the injection pump (3) so that the control rod (7) should be
pushed by the idling adjusting spring (6) at its end and the pin
(10) on the rod engages with the slot (9) on the fork lever (as
shown in the figure).
NOTE
• The sealant is applied to both sides of the soft metal gasket
shim. The liquid gasket is not required for assembling.
• Addition or reduction of shim (0.05 mm, 0.0020 in.) delays
or advances the injection timing by approx. 0.009 rad.
(0.5 °).
• In disassembling and replacing, be sure to use the same
number of new gasket shims with the same thickness.
(1) Screw and Copper Washers (6) Idling Adjusting Spring
(2) Speed Control Plate (7) Control Rod
(3) Injection Pump (8) Slot (Crankcase Side)
(4) Governor Spring (9) Slot (Fork Lever Side)
(5) Governor Lever (10) Pin
9Y1210595ENS0098US0

1-S25

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE
Fan Drive Pulley
1. Secure the flywheel to keep it from turning.
2. Remove the fan drive pulley screw.
3. Draw out the fan drive pulley with a puller.
(When reassembling)
• Install the pulley to crankshaft, aligning the mark (1) on them.
• Apply engine oil to the fan drive pulley retaining screws. And
tighten them.
98.1 to 107 N·m
Tightening torque Fan drive pulley screw 10.0 to 11.0 kgf·m
72.4 to 79.5 lbf·ft

(1) Alignment Mark


9Y1210595ENS0036US0
Gear Case
1. Remove the screw (1) of inside the gear case and outside
screws (6).
2. Disconnect the start spring (2) from the fork lever 1.
3. Remove the gear case (3).
(When reassembling)
• Apply a liquid gasket (Three Bond 1215 or equivalent) to both
sides of the gear case gasket (4).
• Be sure to set three O-rings (5) inside the gear case.
(1) Screw (Inside) (4) Gear Case Gasket
(2) Start Spring (5) O-rings
(3) Gear Case (6) Screw
9Y1210595ENS0037US0

1-S26

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE
Idle Gear
1. Remove the external snap ring (3), the collar (2) and the idle
gear (1).
2. Remove the idle gear shaft mounting screws (4).
3. Remove the idle gear shaft (5).
(When reassembling)
• Apply engine oil to the idle gear shaft mounting screw (4). And
tighten them.
• Install the idle gear, aligning the mark (6) on the gears referring
to the photo.
9.81 to 11.2 N·m
Idle gear shaft mounting
Tightening torque 1.00 to 1.15 kgf·m
screw
7.24 to 8.31 lbf·ft

(1) Idle Gear (4) Idle Gear Shaft Mounting Screw


(2) Idle Gear Collar (5) Idle Gear Shaft
(3) External Snap Ring (6) Mark
9Y1210595ENS0038US0

Camshaft
1. Remove the camshaft mounting screws (1) and draw out the
camshaft with gear (2) on it.
(When reassembling)
• When install the camshaft, apply engine oil to the camshaft
journals.
• Apply engine oil to the camshaft mounting screws. And tighten
them.
(1) Camshaft Mounting Screw (2) Camshaft Gear
9Y1210595ENS0039US0

1-S27

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE
Fuel Camshaft
1. Remove the retaining plate (1).
2. Remove the fork lever holder mounting screws (8), then draw
out the injection pump gear (3) and fuel camshaft (2) with the
governor fork assembly.
(When reassembling)
• Hook the governor spring (7) to the fork lever 2 (6) as shown in
the figure before installing the fork lever assembly to the
crankcase.
(1) Retaining Plate (5) Fork Lever 1
(2) Fuel Camshaft (6) Fork Lever 2
(3) Injection Pump Gear (7) Governor Spring
(4) Governor Sleeve (8) Fork Lever Holder Mounting Screw
9Y1210595ENS0040US0

Oil Pump and Crankshaft Gear


1. Remove the oil pump gear (6).
2. Remove the oil pump (5).
3. Remove the collar (4), O-ring (3) and crankshaft oil slinger (2).
4. Remove the crankshaft gear (1).
(When reassembling)
• Install the collar (4) after aligning the marks on the gears. (See
the figure at "Idle Gear".)
(1) Crankshaft Gear (4) Crankshaft Collar
(2) Crankshaft Oil Slinger (5) Oil Pump
(3) O-ring (6) Oil Pump Gear
9Y1210595ENS0041US0

1-S28

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE
Oil Pan and Oil Strainer
1. Remove the oil pan mounting screws (5).
2. Remove the oil pan (4) by lightly tapping the rim of the pan with
a wooden hammer.
3. Remove the oil strainer (3).
(When reassembling)
• After cleaning the oil strainer, check to see that the filter mesh
in clean, and install it.
• Visually check the O-ring (1), apply engine oil, and install it.
• Securely fit the O-ring to the oil strainer.
• To avoid uneven tightening, tighten oil pan mounting screws in
diagonal order form the center.
• Using the hole (6) numbered "2", install the oil strainer by
mounting screw.
NOTE
• Scrape off the old adhesive completely. Wipe the sealing
surface clean using waste cloth soaked with gasoline. Now
apply new adhesive 3.0 to 5.0 mm (0.12 to 0.19 in.) thick all
over the contact surface. Apply the adhesive also on the
center of the flange as well as on the inner wall of each bolt
hole.
• Cut the nozzle of the "liquid gasket" (Three Bond 1207D or
equivalent) container at its second notch. Apply "liquid
gasket" about 5.0 mm (0.19 in.) thick.
Within 20 minutes after the application of fluid sealant,
reassemble the components. Wait then for about
30 minutes, and pour oil in the crankcase.
(1) O-ring (4) Oil Pan
(2) Screw (5) Oil Pan Mounting Screws
(3) Oil Strainer (6) Hole
9Y1210595ENS0042US0

(3) Piston and Connecting Rod


Connecting Rods
1. Remove the connecting rod caps (1).
(When reassembling)
• Align the marks (a) with each other. (Face the marks toward the
injection pump.)
• Apply engine oil to the connecting rod screws and lightly screw
it in by hand, then tighten it to the specified torque.
If the connecting rod screw won't be screwed in smoothly, clean
the threads.
If the connecting rod screw is still hard to screw in, replace it.
27 to 30 N·m
Tightening torque Connecting rod screw 2.7 to 3.1 kgf·m
20 to 22 lbf·ft

(1) Connecting Rod Cap (a) Mark


9Y1210595ENS0043US0

1-S29

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE
Pistons
1. Turn the flywheel and bring the piston to top dead center.
2. Draw out the piston upward by lightly tapping it from the bottom
of the crankcase with the grip of a hammer.
3. Draw out the other piston in the same method as above.
(When reassembling)
• Before inserting the piston into the cylinder, apply enough
engine oil to the piston.
• When inserting the piston into the cylinder, face the mark on the
connecting rod to the injection pump.
IMPORTANT
• Do not change the combination of cylinder and piston.
Make sure of the position of each piston by marking. For
example, mark "1" on the No. 1 piston.
• When installing the piston into the cylinder, place the gaps
of all of the piston rings as shown in the figure.
• Carefully insert the pistons using a piston ring compressor
(1). Otherwise, their chrome-plated section may be
scratched, causing trouble inside the cylinder.
(1) Piston Ring Compressor (a) 0.79 rad. (45 °)
(b) 0.79 rad. (45 °)
(A) Top Ring Gap (c) 1.6 rad. (90 °)
(B) Second Ring Gap
(C) Oil Ring Gap
(D) Piston Pin Hole
9Y1210595ENS0044US0

1-S30

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE
Piston Ring and Connecting Rod
1. Remove the piston rings using a piston ring tool (Code No.
07909-32121).
2. Remove the piston pin (7), and separate the connecting rod (6)
from the piston (5).
(When reassembling)
• When installing the ring, assemble the rings so that the
manufacturer's mark (12) near the gap faces the top of the
piston.
• When installing the oil ring onto the piston, place the expander
joint (10) on the opposite side of the oil ring gap (11).
• Apply engine oil to the piston pin.
• When installing the connecting rod to the piston, immerse the
piston in 80 °C (176 °F) oil for 10 to 15 minutes and insert the
piston pin to the piston.
• When installing the connecting rod to the piston, align the mark
(8) on the connecting rod to the fan-shaped concave (9).
NOTE
• Mark the same number on the connecting rod and the
piston so as not to change the combination.
(1) Top Ring (7) Piston Pin
(2) Second Ring (8) Mark
(3) Oil Ring (9) Fan-Shaped Concave
(4) Piston Pin Snap Ring (10) Expander Joint
(5) Piston (11) Oil Ring Gap
(6) Connecting Rod (12) Manufacturer's Mark
9Y1210595ENS0045US0

1-S31

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE

(4) Crankshaft
Flywheel
1. Secure the flywheel to keep it from turning using a flywheel
stopper. (Refer to G-54.)
2. Remove all flywheel screws (1) and then remove the flywheel
(2).
(When reassembling)
• Align the "1TC" mark (a) on the outer surface of the flywheel
horizontally with the alignment mark (b) on the rear end plate.
Now fit the flywheel in position.
• Apply engine oil to the threads and the undercut surface of the
flywheel screw and fit the screw.
54 to 58 N·m
Tightening torque Flywheel screw 5.5 to 6.0 kgf·m
40 to 43 lbf·ft

(1) Flywheel Screw (a) 1TC Mark


(2) Flywheel (b) Alignment Mark
9Y1210595ENS0046US0
Bearing Case Cover
1. Remove the bearing case cover mounting screws. First, remove
inside screws (1) and then outside screws (2).
2. Remove the bearing case cover (6).
(When reassembling)
• Fit the bearing case gasket (3) and the bearing case cover
gasket (4) with correct directions.
• Install the bearing case cover (6) to position the casting mark
"UP" (a) on it upward.
• Apply engine oil to the oil seal (5) lip and be careful that it is not
rolled when installing.
• Tighten the bearing case cover mounting screws with even
force on the diagonal line.
9.81 to 11.2 N·m
Bearing case cover
Tightening torque 1.00 to 1.15 kgf·m
mounting screw
7.24 to 8.31 lbf·ft

(1) Bearing Case Cover Mounting (5) Oil Seal


Screw (Inside) (6) Bearing Case Cover
(2) Bearing Case Cover Mounting
Screw (Outside) (a) Top Mark "UP"
(3) Bearing Case Gasket (b) Upside
(4) Bearing Case Cover Gasket
9Y1210595ENS0099US0

1-S32

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE
Crankshaft Assembly
1. Remove the main bearing case screw 2 (1).
2. Pull out the crankshaft assembly.
(When reassembling)
• Clean the oil passage of the crankshaft with compressed air.
• Apply oil to the main bearing case screw 2 (1).
• Install the crankshaft assembly, aligning the screw hole of main
bearing case with the screw hole of crankcase.
27 to 30 N·m
Tightening torque Main bearing case screw 2 2.7 to 3.1 kgf·m
20 to 22 lbf·ft

(1) Main Bearing Case Screw 2


9Y1210595ENS0048US0

1-S33

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE
Main Bearing Case Assembly
1. Remove the two main bearing case screws 1 (1), and remove
the main bearing case assembly 1 (2), being careful with
crankshaft bearing 3 (4), (5).
2. Remove the main bearing case assembly (3) as above. Keep in
mind, however, that the thrust bearing (8) is installed in the main
bearing case assembly (3).
(When reassembling)
• Clean the oil passage in the main bearing cases.
• Apply clean engine oil on the bearings.
• Install the main bearing case assemblies in original positions.
Since diameters of main bearing cases vary, install them in
order to marking (b) from the gear case side. (Refer to the
figure.)
• Match the alignment numbers (a) on the main bearing case
assembly 1.
• Do the same for the main bearing case assembly (3) too.
• When installing the main bearing case 1, face the mark
"FLYWHEEL" to the flywheel.
• Install the thrust bearing (8) with its oil groove facing outward.
• Make sure that the main bearing case moves smoothly after
tightening the main bearing case screw 1 to the specified
torque.
13 to 15 N·m
Tightening torque Main bearing case screw 1 1.3 to 1.6 kgf·m
9.4 to 11 lbf·ft

(1) Main Bearing Case Screw 1 (a) Alignment Number


(2) Main Bearing Case Assembly 1 (b) Marking
(3) Main Bearing Case Assembly (c) Oil Groove
(4) Crankshaft Bearing 3
(Upper, with oil groove)
(5) Crankshaft Bearing 3 (Lower)
(6) Crankshaft Bearing 2
(Upper, with oil groove)
(7) Crankshaft Bearing 2 (Lower)
(8) Thrust Bearing
9Y1210595ENS0100US0

1-S34

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE

(5) Water Pump


Thermostat Assembly
1. Remove the thermostat cover mounting screws, and remove
the thermostat cover (1).
2. Remove the thermostat assembly (3).
(When reassembling)
• Apply a liquid gasket (Three Bond 1215 or equivalent) only at
the thermostat cover side of the gasket (2).
(1) Thermostat Cover (3) Thermostat Assembly
(2) Thermostat Cover Gasket
9Y1210595ENS0050US0

Water pump Assembly


1. Loosen the dynamo mounting screws, and remove the fan belt.
2. Remove the fan and fan pulley.
3. Remove the water pump assembly from the gear case cover.
4. Remove the water pump flange (1).
5. Press out the water pump shaft (2) with the impeller (5) on it.
6. Remove the impeller from the water pump shaft.
7. Remove the mechanical seal (4).
(When reassembling)
• Apply a liquid gasket (Three Bond 1215 or equivalent) to the
both sides of gasket.
• Replace the mechanical seal with new one.
(1) Water Pump Flange (4) Mechanical Seal
(2) Water pump Shaft (5) Impeller
(3) Water Pump Body
9Y1210595ENS0051US0

(6) Injection Nozzle


Nozzle Holder
1. Secure the nozzle retaining nut (7) with a vise.
2. Remove the nozzle holder (1), and remove parts inside.
(When reassembling)
• Assemble the nozzle in clean fuel oil.
• Install the push rod (4), noting its direction.
• After assembling the nozzle, be sure to adjust the fuel injection
pressure.
35 to 39 N·m
Nozzle holder 3.5 to 4.0 kgf·m
26 to 28 lbf·ft
20 to 24 N·m
Tightening torque Overflow pipe nut 2.0 to 2.5 kgf·m
15 to 18 lbf·ft
49 to 68 N·m
Nozzle holder assembly 5.0 to 7.0 kgf·m
37 to 50 lbf·ft

(1) Nozzle Holder (5) Distance Piece


(2) Adjusting Washer (6) Nozzle Piece
(3) Nozzle Spring (7) Nozzle Retaining Nut
(4) Push Rod
9Y1210595ENS0101US0

1-S35

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE

[4] SERVICING
(1) Cylinder Head and Valves
Cylinder Head Surface Flatness
1. Clean the cylinder head surface.
2. Place a straightedge on the cylinder head's four sides and two
diagonal as shown in the figure.
3. Measure the clearance with a thickness gauge.
4. If the measurement exceeds the allowable limit, correct it with a
surface grinder.
IMPORTANT
• Do not place the straightedge on the combustion chamber.
• Be sure to check the valve recessing after correcting.
Cylinder head surface 0.05 mm
Allowable limit
flatness 0.002 in.
9Y1210595ENS0053US0

Cylinder Head Flaw


1. Prepare an air spray red check (Code No. 07909-31371).
2. Clean the surface of the cylinder head with detergent (2).
3. Spray the cylinder head surface with the red permeative liquid
(1). Leave it five to ten minutes after spraying.
4. Wash away the read permeative liquid on the cylinder head
surface with the detergent (2).
5. Spray the cylinder head surface with white developer (3)
6. If flawed, it can be identified as red marks.
(1) Red Permeative Liquid (3) White Developer
(2) Detergent
9Y1210595ENS0054US0
Valve Recessing
1. Clean the cylinder head surface, valve face and valve seat.
2. Insert the valve into the valve guide.
3. Measure the valve recessing with a depth gauge.
4. If the measurement exceeds the allowable limit, replace the
valve.
5. If it still exceeds the allowable limit after replacing the valve,
replace the cylinder head.
0.10 (protrusion) to
0.10 (recessing) mm
Factory specification
Valve recessing 0.0039 (protrusion) to
(Intake and Exhaust) 0.0039 (recessing) in.
0.30 (recessing) mm
Allowable limit
0.012 (recessing) in.

(1) Cylinder Head Surface (A) Recessing


(B) Protrusion
9Y1210595ENS0055US0

1-S36

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE
Clearance between Valve Stem and Valve Guide
1. Remove carbon from the valve guide section.
2. Measure the valve stem O.D. with an outside micrometer.
3. Measure the valve guide I.D. with a small hole gauge, and
calculate the clearance.
4. If the clearance exceeds the allowable limit, replace the valves.
If it still exceeds the allowable limit, replace the valve guide.
0.030 to 0.057 mm
Clearance between Factory specification
0.0012 to 0.0022 in.
valve stem and valve
guide 0.10 mm
Allowable limit
0.0039 in.

5.968 to 5.980 mm
Valve stem O.D. Factory specification
0.2350 to 0.2354 in.
6.010 to 6.025 mm
Valve stem O.D. Factory specification
0.2367 to 0.2372 in.
9Y1210595ENS0056US0

Replacing Valve Guide


(When removing)
1. Press out the used valve guide using a valve guide replacing
tool.
(When installing)
1. Clean a new valve guide and valve guide bore, and apply
engine oil to them.
2. Press in a new valve guide using a valve guide replacing tool.
3. Ream precisely the I.D. of the valve guide to the specified
dimension.
Valve guide I.D. 6.010 to 6.025 mm
Factory specification
(Intake and Exhaust) 0.2367 to 0.2372 in.

IMPORTANT
• Do not hit the valve guide with a hammer during
replacement.
(A) When removing (B) When installing
9Y1210595ENS0057US0

1-S37

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE
Valve Seating
1. Coat the valve face lightly with prussian blue and put the valve
on its seat to check the contact.
2. If the valve does not seat all the way around the valve seat or
the valve contact is less than 70 %, correct the valve seating as
follows.
3. If the valve contact does not comply with the reference value,
replace the valve or correct the contact of valve seating.
2.12 mm
Valve seat width Factory specification
0.0835 in.

(1) Correct (3) Incorrect


(2) Incorrect
9Y1210595ENS0058US0

Correcting Valve and Valve Seat


NOTE
• Before correcting the valve and seat, check the valve stem
and the I.D. of valve guide section, and repair them if
necessary.
• After correcting the valve seat, be sure to check the valve
recessing.
1) Correcting Valve
1. Correct the valve with a valve refacer.
0.79 rad
Valve face angle Factory specification
45 °

2) Correcting Valve Seat


1. Slightly correct the seat surface with a 0.79 rad (45 °) valve seat
cutter (Code No. 07909-33102).
2. Fitting the valve, check the contact position of the valve face
and seat surface with prussian blue. (Visual check) [If the valve
has been used for a long period, the seat tends to come in
contact with the upper side of the valve face.]
3. Grind the upper surface of the seat with a 0.26 rad (15 °) valve
seat cutter until the valve seat touches to the center of the valve
face (so that (a) equals (b) as shown in the figure).
4. Grind the seat with a 0.79 rad (45 °) valve seat cutter again, and
visually recheck the contact between the valve and seat.
5. Repeat steps 3 and 4 until the correct contact is achieved.
6. Continue lapping until the seated rate becomes more than 70 %
of the total contact area.
0.79 rad
Valve seat angle Factory specification
45 °

(1) Valve Seat Cutter (a) Identical Dimensions


(b) Valve Seat Width
(A) Check Contact (c) 0.26 rad (15 °)
(B) Correct Seat Width (d) 0.79 rad (45 °)
(C) Check Seat Surface
(D) Check Contact
9Y1210595ENS0059US0

1-S38

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE
Valve Lapping
1. Apply compound evenly to the valve lapping surface.
2. Insert the valve into the valve guide. Lap the valve onto its seat
with a valve flapper or screwdriver.
3. After lapping the valve, wash the compound away and apply oil,
then repeat valve lapping with oil.
4. Apply prussian blue to the contact surface to check the seated
rate. If it is less than 70 %, repeat valve lapping again.
IMPORTANT
• When valve lapping is performed, be sure to check the
valve recessing and adjust the valve clearance after
assembling the valve.
9Y1210595ENS0060US0
Free Length and Tilt of Valve Spring
1. Measure the free length (A) of valve spring with vernier calipers.
If the measurement is less than the allowable limit, replace it.
2. Put the valve spring on a surface plate, place a square on the
side of the valve spring.
3. Check to see if the entire side is in contact with the square.
Rotate the valve spring and measure the maximum tilt (B).
If the measurement exceeds the allowable limit, replace it.
4. Check the entire surface of the valve spring for scratches.
If there is any problem, replace it.
31.3 to 31.8 mm
Factory specification
1.24 to 1.25 in.
Free length (A)
28.4 mm
Allowable limit
1.12 in.

1.2 mm
Tilt (B) Allowable limit
0.047 in.

(A) Free Length (B) Tilt


9Y1210595ENS0102US0
Valve Spring Setting Load
1. Place the valve spring on a tester and compress it to the same
length it is actually compressed the engine.
2. Read the compression load on the gauge.
3. If the measurement is less than the allowable limit, replace it.
65 N / 27.0 mm
Factory specification 6.6 kgf / 27.0 mm
Setting load / 15 lbs / 1.06 in.
Setting length 55 N / 27.0 mm
Allowable limit 5.6 kgf / 27.0 mm
12 lbs / 1.06 in.
9Y1210595ENS0062US0

1-S39

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE
Oil Clearance between Rocker Arm and Rocker Arm Shaft
1. Measure the rocker arm shaft O.D. with an outside micrometer.
2. Measure the rocker arm I.D. with an inside micrometer, and
then calculate the oil clearance.
3. If the oil clearance exceeds the allowable limit, replace the
rocker arm and measure the oil clearance again. If it still
exceeds the allowable limit, replace also the rocker arm shaft.
0.016 to 0.045 mm
Oil clearance between Factory specification
0.00063 to 0.0017 in.
rocker arm and rocker
arm shaft 0.15 mm
Allowable limit
0.0059 in.

10.473 to 10.484 mm
Rocker arm shaft O.D. Factory specification
0.41233 to 0.41275 in.
10.500 to 10.518 mm
Rocker arm I.D. Factory specification
0.41339 to 0.41409 in.
9Y1210595ENS0063US0
Push Rod Alignment
1. Place the push rod on V blocks.
2. Measure the push rod alignment.
3. If the measurement exceeds the allowable limit, replace the
push rod.
0.25 mm
Push rod alignment Allowable limit
0.0098 in.
9Y1210595ENS0064US0

Oil Clearance between Tappet and Tappet Guide Bore


1. Measure the tappet O.D. with an outside micrometer.
2. Measure the I.D. of the tappet guide bore with a cylinder gauge,
and calculate the oil clearance.
3. If the oil clearance exceeds the allowable limit or the tappet is
damaged, replace the tappet.
0.016 to 0.052 mm
Oil clearance between Factory specification
0.00063 to 0.0020 in.
tappet and tappet guide
bore 0.10 mm
Allowable limit
0.0039 in.

17.966 to 17.984 mm
Tappet O.D. Factory specification
0.70733 to 0.70803 in.
18.000 to 18.018 mm
Tappet guide bore I.D. Factory specification
0.70866 to 0.70937 in.
9Y1210595ENS0065US0

1-S40

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE

(2) Timing Gear, Camshaft and Fuel Camshaft


Timing Gear Backlash
1. Set a dial indicator (lever type) with its tip on the gear tooth.
2. Move the gear to measure the backlash, holding its mating gear.
3. If the backlash exceeds the allowable limit, check the oil
clearance of the shafts and the gear.
4. If the oil clearance is proper, replace the gear.
0.0430 to 0.124 mm
Factory specification
Backlash between idle 0.00170 to 0.00488 in.
gear and crank gear 0.15 mm
Allowable limit
0.0059 in.

0.0470 to 0.123 mm
Factory specification
Backlash between idle 0.00185 to 0.00484 in.
gear and cam gear 0.15 mm
Allowable limit
0.0059 in.

0.0460 to 0.124 mm
Backlash between idle Factory specification
0.00182 to 0.00488 in.
gear and injection pump
gear 0.15 mm
Allowable limit
0.0059 in.

0.0410 to 0.123 mm
Backlash between oil Factory specification
0.00162 to 0.00484 in.
pump drive gear and
crank gear 0.15 mm
Allowable limit
0.0059 in.
9Y1210595ENS0066US0
Idle Gear Side Clearance
1. Set a dial indicator with its tip on the idle gear.
2. Measure the side clearance by moving the idle gear to the front
and rear.
3. If the measurement exceeds the allowable limit, replace the idle
gear collar.
0.20 to 0.51 mm
Factory specification
0.0079 to 0.020 in.
Idle gear side clearance
0.80 mm
Allowable limit
0.031 in.
9Y1210595ENS0067US0
Camshaft Side Clearance
1. Set a dial indicator with its tip on the camshaft.
2. Measure the side clearance by moving the cam gear to the font
and rear.
3. If the measurement exceeds the allowable limit, replace the
camshaft stopper.
0.15 to 0.31 mm
Factory specification
0.0059 to 0.012 in.
Camshaft side clearance
0.50 mm
Allowable limit
0.020 in.
9Y1210595ENS0068US0

1-S41

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE
Camshaft Alignment
1. Support the camshaft with V blocks on the surface plate at both
end journals.
2. Set a dial indicator with its tip on the intermediate journal.
3. Measure the camshaft alignment.
4. If the measurement exceeds the allowable limit, replace the
camshaft.
0.01 mm
Camshaft alignment Allowable limit
0.0039 in.
9Y1210595ENS0069US0
Cam Height
1. Measure the height of the cam at its highest point with an
outside micrometer.
2. If the measurement is less than the allowable limit, replace the
camshaft.
26.88 mm
Factory specification
Cam height of intake and 1.058 in.
exhaust 26.83 mm
Allowable limit
1.056 in.
9Y1210595ENS0070US0
Oil Clearance of Camshaft Journal
1. Measure the camshaft journal O.D. with an outside micrometer.
2. Measure the cylinder block bore I.D. for camshaft with a cylinder
gauge, and calculate the oil clearance.
3. If the oil clearance exceeds the allowable limit, replace the
camshaft.
0.050 to 0.091 mm
Factory specification
Oil clearance of 0.0020 to 0.0035 in.
camshaft journal 0.15 mm
Allowable limit
0.0059 in.

32.934 to 32.950 mm
Camshaft journal O.D. Factory specification
1.2967 to 1.2972 in.
Camshaft bearing I.D. 33.000 to 33.025 mm
Factory specification
(Cylinder block bore I.D.) 1.2993 to 1.3001 in.
9Y1210595ENS0071US0

1-S42

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE
Oil Clearance between Idle Gear Shaft and Idle Gear Bushing
1. Measure the idle gear shaft O.D. with an outside micrometer.
2. Measure the idle gear bushing I.D. with an inside micrometer,
and calculate the oil clearance.
3. If the oil clearance exceeds the allowable limit, replace the
bushing.
4. If it still exceeds the allowable limit, replace the idle gear shaft.
0.020 to 0.084 mm
Oil clearance between Factory specification
0.00079 to 0.0033 in.
idle gear shaft and idle
gear bushing 0.10 mm
Allowable limit
0.0039 in.

19.967 to 19.980 mm
Idle gear shaft O.D. Factory specification
0.78611 to 0.78660 in.
20.000 to 20.051 mm
Idle gear bushing I.D. Allowable limit
0.78741 to 0.78940 in.
9Y1210595ENS0072US0

Replacing Idle Gear Bushing


(When removing)
1. Press out the used idle gear bushing using an idle gear bushing
replacing tool.
(When installing)
1. Clean a new idle gear bushing and idle gear bore, and apply
engine oil to them.
2. Press in a new brushing using an idle gear bushing replacing
tool, until it is flush with the end of the idle gear.
(A) When removing (B) When installing
9Y1210595ENS0073US0

(3) Piston and Connecting Rod


Piston Pin Bore I.D.
1. Measure the piston pin bore I.D. in both the horizontal and
vertical directions with a cylinder gauge.
2. If the measurement exceeds the allowable limit, replace the
piston.
20.000 to 20.013 mm
Factory specification
0.78741 to 0.78791 in.
Piston pin bore I.D.
20.05 mm
Allowable limit
0.7894 in.
9Y1210595ENS0074US0

1-S43

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE
Oil Clearance between Piton Pin and Small End Bushing
1. Measure the piston pin O.D. where it contacts the bushing with
an outside micrometer.
2. Measure the small end bushing I.D. with an inside micrometer,
and calculate the oil clearance.
3. If the oil clearance exceeds the allowable limit, replace the
bushing. If it still exceeds the allowable limit, replace the piston
pin.
0.014 to 0.038 mm
Oil clearance between Factory specification
0.00056 to 0.0014 in.
piston pin and small end
bushing 0.10 mm
Allowable limit
0.0039 in.

20.002 to 20.011 mm
Piston pin O.D. Factory specification
0.78748 to 0.78783 in.
20.025 to 20.040 mm
Small end bushing I.D. Factory specification
0.78839 to 0.78897 in.
9Y1210595ENS0075US0
Replacing Small End Bushing
(When removing)
1. Press out the used bushing using a small end bushing replacing
tool.
(When installing)
1. Clean a new small end bushing and bore, and apply engine oil
to them.
2. Insert a new bushing onto the tool and press-fit it with a press
so that the seam (1) of bushing positions as shown in the figure,
until it is flush with the connecting rod.
3. Drill a hole to the bushing with aligning the oil hole (2) of
connecting rod. (Refer to the figure.)
NOTE
• Be sure to chamfer the oil hole circumference with an oil
stone.
0.015 to 0.075 mm
Oil clearance between Factory specification
0.00059 to 0.0029 in.
piston pin and small end
bushing (Spare parts) 0.15 mm
Allowable limit
0.0059 in.

Small end bushing I.D. 20.026 to 20.077 mm


Factory specification
(Spare parts) 0.78843 to 0.79043 in.

(1) Seam (A) When removing


(2) Oil Hole (B) When installing
(a) 0.79 rad (45 °)
9Y1210595ENS0076US0

1-S44

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE
Piston Ring Gap
1. Insert the piston ring into the lower part of the cylinder (the least
worn out part) with piston.
2. Measure the ring gap with a thickness gauge.
3. If the measurement exceeds the allowable limit, replace the
piston ring.
Factory
0.15 to 0.30 mm
specifica-
0.0059 to 0.011 in.
Top ring tion
Allowable 1.20 mm
limit 0.0472 in.
Factory
0.30 to 0.40 mm
specifica-
Second 0.012 to 0.015 in.
Piston ring gap tion
ring
Allowable 1.20 mm
limit 0.0472 in.
Factory
0.15 to 0.30 mm
specifica-
0.0059 to 0.011 in.
Oil ring tion
Allowable 1.20 mm
limit 0.0472 in.
9Y1210595ENS0077US0
Clearance between Piston Ring and Piston Ring Groove
1. Clean the rings and the ring grooves, and install each ring in its
groove.
2. Measure the clearance between the ring and the groove with a
thickness gauge.
3. If the clearance exceeds the allowable limit, replace the piston
ring.
4. If the clearance still exceeds the allowable limit with new ring,
replace the piston.
Factory
0.0850 to 0.115 mm
specifica-
Second 0.00335 to 0.00452 in.
tion
ring
Allowable 0.15 mm
Clearance between limit 0.0059 in.
piston ring and piston
ring groove Factory
0.02 to 0.06 mm
specifica-
0.0008 to 0.002 in.
Oil ring tion
Allowable 0.15 mm
limit 0.0059 in.
9Y1210595ENS0078US0
Connecting Rod Alignment
1. Remove the crankpin bearing, and install the connecting rod
cap.
2. Install the piston pin in the connecting rod.
3. Install the connecting rod on the connecting rod alignment tool
(Code No. 07909-31661).
4. Put a gauge over the piston pin, and move it against the face
plate.
5. If the gauge does not fit squarely against the face plate,
measure the space between the pin of the gauge and the face
plate.
6. If the measurement exceeds the allowable limit, replace the
connecting rod.
Space between gauge 0.05 mm
Allowable limit
pin face plate 0.0020 in.
9Y1210595ENS0079US0

1-S45

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE

(4) Crankshaft
Crankshaft Side Clearance
1. Set a dial indicator with its tip on the end of the crankshaft.
2. Measure the side clearance by moving the crankshaft to the
front and rear.
3. If the measurement exceeds the allowable limit, replace the
thrust bearings.
4. If the same size bearing is useless because of the crankshaft
journal wear, replace it with an oversize one referring to the
table and figure.
0.15 to 0.30 mm
Factory specification
Crankshaft side 0.0059 to 0.011 in.
clearance 0.50 mm
Allowable limit
0.0197 in.

(Reference)
• Oversize thrust bearing
Oversize Bearing Code Number Marking

0.2 mm Thrust bearing 1 02 15261-23950 020 OS


0.008 in. Thrust bearing 2 02 15261-23970 020 OS

0.4 mm Thrust bearing 1 04 15261-23960 040 OS


0.016 in. Thrust bearing 2 04 15261-23980 040 OS
• Oversize dimensions of crankshaft journal
0.20 mm 0.40 mm
Oversize
0.0079 in. 0.015 in.
23.40 to 23.45 mm 23.80 to 23.85 mm
Dimension A
0.9213 to 0.9232 in. 0.9370 to 0.9390 in.
46.10 to 46.30 mm 46.30 to 46.50 mm
Dimension B
1.815 to 1.823 in. 1.823 to 1.831 in.
1.8 to 2.2 mm radius 1.8 to 2.2 mm radius
Dimension C
0.071 to 0.086 in. radius 0.071 to 0.086 in. radius
The crankshaft journal must be fine-finished to higher than Rmax = 0.8S.
9Y1210595ENS0080US0
Crankshaft Alignment
1. Support the crankshaft with V blocks on the surface plate at
both end journals.
2. Set a dial indicator with its tip on the intermediate journal.
3. Measure the crankshaft alignment.
4. If the measurement exceeds the allowable limit, replace the
crankshaft.
0.02 mm
Crankshaft alignment Allowable limit
0.0008 in.
9Y1210595ENS0081US0

1-S46

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE
Oil Clearance between Crankpin and Crankpin Bearing
1. Clean the crankpin and crankpin bearing.
2. Put a strip of plastigauge (Code No.: 07909-30241) on the
center of the crankpin.
3. Install the connecting rod cap and tighten the connecting rod
screws to the specified torque, and remove the cap again.
4. Measure the amount of the flattening with the scale, and get the
oil clearance.
5. If the oil clearance exceeds the allowable limit, replace the
crankpin bearing.
6. If the same size bearing is useless because of the crankpin
wear, replace it with an undersize one referring to the table and
figure.
NOTE
• Never insert the plastigauge into the crankpin oil hole.
• Be sure not to move the crankshaft while the connecting
rod screws are tightened.
0.020 to 0.051 mm
Oil clearance between Factory specification
0.00079 to 0.0020 in.
crankpin and crankpin
bearing 0.15 mm
Allowable limit
0.0059 in.

33.959 to 33.975 mm
Crankpin O.D. Factory specification
1.3370 to 1.3375 in.
33.995 to 34.010 mm
Crankpin bearing I.D. Allowable limit
1.3384 to 1.3389 in.

(Reference)
• Undersize crankpin bearing
Undersize Bearing Code Number Marking
0.20 mm
Crankpin bearing 02 15861-22970 020 US
0.0079 in.
0.40 mm
Crankpin bearing 04 15861-22980 040 US
0.015 in.
• Undersize dimensions of crankpin
0.20 mm 0.40 mm
Undersize
0.0079 in. 0.015 in.
2.3 to 2.7 mm radius 2.3 to 2.7 mm radius
Dimension A
0.091 to 0.106 in. radius 0.091 to 0.106 in. radius
1.0 to 1.5 mm relief 1.0 to 1.5 mm relief
Dimension B
0.040 to 0.059 in. relief 0.040 to 0.059 in. relief
33.759 to 33.775 mm dia. 33.559 to 33.575 mm dia.
Dimension C
1.3291 to 1.3297 in. dia. 1.3213 to 1.3218 in. dia.
The crankpin must be fine-finished to higher than Rmax = 0.8S.
*Holes to be de-burred and edges rounded with 1.0 to 1.5 mm
(0.0394 to 0.0591 in.) relief.
9Y1210595ENS0082US0

1-S47

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE
Oil Clearance between Crankshaft Journal and Crankshaft
Bearing 1
1. Measure the O.D. of the crankshaft front journal with an outside
micrometer.
2. Measure the I.D. of the crankshaft bearing 1 with an inside
micrometer, and calculate the oil clearance.
3. If the oil clearance exceeds the allowable limit, replace the
crankshaft bearing 1.
4. If the same size bearing is useless because of the crankshaft
journal wear, replace it with an undersize one referring to the
table and the figure.
0.0340 to 0.106 mm
Oil Clearance between Factory specification
0.00134 to 0.00417 in.
crankshaft journal and
crankshaft bearing 1 0.20 mm
Allowable limit
0.0079 in.

39.934 to 39.950 mm
Crankshaft journal O.D. Factory specification
1.5722 to 1.5728 in.
39.984 to 40.040 mm
Crankshaft bearing 1 I.D. Factory specification
1.5742 to 1.5763 in.

(Reference)
• Undersize crankshaft bearing 1
Undersize Bearing Code Number Marking
0.2 mm
Crankshaft bearing 1 02 15861-23910 020 US
0.008 in.
0.4 mm
Crankshaft bearing 1 04 15861-23920 040 US
0.016 in.
• Undersize dimensions of crankshaft journal
0.2 mm 0.4 mm
Undersize
0.008 in. 0.016 in.
1.8 to 2.2 mm radius 1.8 to 2.2 mm radius
Dimension A
0.071 to 0.086 in. radius 0.071 to 0.086 in. radius
5 mm dia. 5 mm dia.
Dimension B
0.2 in. dia. 0.2 in. dia.
39.734 to 39.750 mm dia. 39.534 to 39.550 mm dia.
Dimension C
1.5644 to 1.5649 in. dia. 1.5565 to 1.5570 in. dia.
The crankshaft journal must be fine-finished to higher than Rmax = 0.8S.
9Y1210595ENS0083US0
Replacing Crankshaft Bearing 1
(When removing)
1. Press out the used crankshaft bearing 1 using a crankshaft
bearing 1 replacing tool. (Refer to "8. SPECIAL TOOLS" on
page G-50.)
(When installing)
1. Clean a new crankshaft bearing 1 and crankshaft journal bore,
and apply engine oil to them.
2. Using a crankshaft bearing 1 replacing tool, press in a new
bearing 1 (2) so that its seam (1) directs toward the exhaust
manifold side. (See figure.)
0 to 0.3 mm
Dimension (A) Factory specification
0 to 0.01 in.

(1) Seam (A) Dimension


(2) Crankshaft Bearing 1
(3) Cylinder Block
9Y1210595ENS0084US0

1-S48

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE
Oil Clearance between Crankshaft Journal and Crankshaft
Bearing 2 (Crankshaft Bearing 3)
1. Put a strip of plastigauge (Code No. 07909-30241) on the center
of the journal.
2. Install the bearing case and tighten the bearing case screws 1
to the specified torque, and remove the bearing case again.
3. Measure the amount of the flattening with the scale, and get the
oil clearance.
4. If the oil clearance exceeds the allowable limit, replace the
crankshaft bearing 2 (crankshaft bearing 3).
5. If the same size bearing is useless because of the crankshaft
journal wear, replace it with an undersize one referring to the
table and figure.
NOTE
• Be sure not to move the crankshaft while the bearing case
screws are tightened.
Oil clearance between 0.028 to 0.051 mm
Factory specification
crankshaft journal and 0.0011 to 0.0020 in.
crankshaft bearing 2 0.20 mm
(crankshaft bearing 3) Allowable limit
0.0079 in.

Crankshaft journal O.D. 43.934 to 43.950 mm


Factory specification
(Flywheel side) 1.7297 to 1.7303 in.
Crankshaft bearing 2 43.984 to 44.026 mm
Factory specification
I.D. 1.7317 to 1.7333 in.

Crankshaft journal O.D. 39.934 to 39.950 mm


Factory specification
(Intermediate) 1.5722 to 1.5728 in.
Crankshaft bearing 3 39.984 to 40.026 mm
Factory specification
I.D. 1.5742 to 1.5758 in.

(Reference)
• Undersize crankshaft bearing 2 and 3
Undersize Bearing Code Number Marking

0.20 mm Crankshaft bearing 2 02 15861-23930 020 US


0.0079 in. Crankshaft bearing 3 02 15861-23860 020 US

0.40 mm Crankshaft bearing 2 04 15694-23940 040 US


0.015 in. Crankshaft bearing 3 04 15861-23871 040 US
• Undersize dimensions of crankshaft journal
0.20 mm 0.40 mm
Undersize
0.0079 in. 0.015 in.
1.8 to 2.2 mm radius 1.8 to 2.2 mm radius
Dimension A
0.071 to 0.086 in. radius 0.071 to 0.086 in. radius
1.0 to 1.5 mm relief 1.0 to 1.5 mm relief
*Dimension B
0.040 to 0.059 in. relief 0.040 to 0.059 in. relief
39.734 to 39.750 mm dia. 39.534 to 39.550 mm dia.
Dimension C
1.5644 to 1.5649 in. dia. 1.5565 to 1.5570 in. dia.
43.734 to 43.750 mm dia. 43.534 to 43.550 mm dia.
Dimension D
1.7219 to 1.7224 in. dia. 1.7140 to 1.7145 in. dia.
The crankshaft journal must be fine-finished to higher than Rmax = 0.8S.
*Holes to be de-burred and edges rounded with 1.0 to 1.5 mm
(0.040 to 0.059 in.) relief.
9Y1210595ENS0085US0

1-S49

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE

(5) Cylinder
Cylinder Wear
1. Measure the I.D. of the cylinder at the six positions (see figure)
with a cylinder gauge to find the maximum and minimum I.D.'s.
2. Get the difference (Maximum wear) between the maximum and
the minimum I.D.'s.
3. If the wear exceeds the allowable limit, bore and hone to the
oversize dimension. (Refer to "Correcting Cylinder".)
4. Visually check the cylinder wall for scratches. If deep scratches
are found, the cylinder should be bored. (Refer to "Correcting
Cylinder".)
67.000 to 67.019 mm
Factory specification
2.6378 to 2.6385 in.
Cylinder I.D.
67.169 mm
Allowable limit
2.6444 in.

(A) Top (a) Right-angled to Piston Pin


(B) Middle (b) Piston Pin Direction
(C) Bottom (Skirt)
9Y1210595ENS0086US0

Correcting Cylinder
1. When the cylinder is worn beyond the allowable limit, bore and
hone it to the specified dimension.
67.250 to 67.269 mm
Factory specification
Cylinder I.D. 2.6477 to 2.6483 in.
[Oversize] 67.419 mm
Allowable limit
2.6543 in.
Hone to 1.2 to 2.0 µm Rmax.
Finishing
(0.000048 to 0.000078 in. Rmax.)
2. Replace the piston and piston rings with oversize ones.
Oversize Part Name Code Number Marking

0.25 mm Piston 16851-21900 025


0.0098 in. Piston ring assembly 16851-21090 025

NOTE
• When the oversize cylinder is worn beyond the allowable
limit, replace the cylinder block with a new one.
(1) Cylinder I.D. [Before Correction (2) Cylinder I.D. [Oversize]
9Y1210595ENS0087US0

(6) Oil Pump


Rotor Lobe Clearance
1. Measure the clearance between lobes of the inner rotor and the
outer rotor with a thickness gauge.
2. If the clearance exceeds the factory specifications, replace the
oil pump rotor assembly.
0.030 to 0.14 mm
Rotor lobe clearance Factory specification
0.0012 to 0.0055 in.
9Y1210595ENS0088US0

1-S50

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ENGINE
Clearance between Outer Rotor and Pump Body
1. Measure the clearance between the outer rotor and the pump
body with a thickness gauge.
2. If the clearance exceeds the factory specifications, replace the
oil pump rotor assembly.
Clearance between outer 0.070 to 0.15 mm
Factory specification
rotor and pump body 0.0028 to 0.0059 in.
9Y1210595ENS0089US0

Clearance between Rotor and Cover


1. Put a strip of plastigauge (Code No. 07909-30241) onto the
rotor face with grease.
2. Install the cover and tighten the screws.
3. Remove the cover carefully, and measure the amount of the
flattening with the scale and get the clearance.
4. If the clearance exceeds the factory specifications, replace the
oil pump rotor assembly.
Clearance between rotor 0.075 to 0.135 mm
Factory specification
and cover 0.00296 to 0.00531 in.
9Y1210595ENS0090US0

1-S51

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


2 TRANSAXLE

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


MECHANISM

CONTENTS

1. STRUCTURE.............................................................................................................................. 2-M1
2. TRAVELLING SYSTEM.............................................................................................................. 2-M2
[1] HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION ....................................................................................... 2-M2
(1) Structure ......................................................................................................................... 2-M2
(2) Oil Flow........................................................................................................................... 2-M3
(3) Operation........................................................................................................................ 2-M4
(4) Charge Pump ................................................................................................................. 2-M7
(5) By-pass Valve................................................................................................................. 2-M7
(6) Control Linkage .............................................................................................................. 2-M8
[2] MOWER PTO SYSTEM ....................................................................................................... 2-M9
(1) Mower PTO Clutch ......................................................................................................... 2-M9

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM TRANSAXLE

1. STRUCTURE

(1) Hydraulic Transmission (2) Mower PTO Section (4) Rear Axle Section (6) Bearing which Supports the
Section (3) Differential Gear Section (5) Bearing which Supports the Drive Shaft
Rear Axle

The transaxle of this machine is constructed as shown above.


9Y1210595TXM0002US0

2-M1

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM TRANSAXLE

2. TRAVELLING SYSTEM
[1] HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION
(1) Structure

(1) Check Valve (8) Piston (15) Oil Seal (22) By-pass Plug
(2) Trunnion Arm (9) Spring (Cylinder Block) (16) Pump Shaft (23) By-pass Spool
(3) Charge Relief Valve (10) Washer (17) Ball Bearing (24) By-pass Spring
(4) Charge Pump (11) Thrust Ball Bearing (18) Oil Seal (25) Journal Bearing
(5) Center Section (12) Swashplate (19) Motor Shaft (26) Oil Seal
(6) Cylinder Block (Pump) (13) Cradle Bearing (20) Thrust Ball Bearings (27) Journal Bearing
(7) Piston Spring (14) Ball Bearing (21) Cylinder Block (Motor) (28) Oil Seal

Hydrostatic Transmission (HST) consists of a variable displacement piston pump, a fixed displacement piston
motor, two check valves (1) and a by-pass valve.
The pump and motor have five pistons (8) in their own cylinder block (6), (21).
The discharge rate of the HST is 10 cm3/rev. (0.61 cu. in./rev.).
With the speed change pedal connecting to the trunnion arm (2) in HST via a link mechanism, the speed change
pedal permits simple operation of this machine, starting, stopping and accelerating or decelerating.
This HST has check valves (1) and does not have relief valves.
9Y1210595TXM0003US0

2-M2

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM TRANSAXLE

(2) Oil Flow

(1) Pump (4) Filter Cartridge (7) Lubricating Orifice (9) Neutral Orifice
(2) Charge Pump (5) Motor (8) Check Valve (Reverse) (10) Charge Relief Valve
(3) Check Valve (Forward) (6) By-pass Valve

The closed oil-hydraulic loop connects between the pump (1) and the motor (5) in HST.
Oil from the transaxle flows through the filter cartridge (4). Then the oil passed through the filter cartridge (4) is
routed to HST as charge oil by the charge pump (2) and charge relief valve (10).
Overflow oil from the HST housing flows back to the transaxle.
9Y1210595TXM0004US0

2-M3

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM TRANSAXLE

(3) Operation
Neutral

(1) Cylinder Block (Pump) (5) Lubricating Orifice (8) Transaxle Case (11) Charge Relief Valve
(2) Swashplate (6) Check Valve (Forward) (9) Oil Strainer (12) Filter Cartridge
(3) Piston (7) By-pass Valve (10) Check Valve (Reverse) (13) Charge Pump
(4) Cylinder Block (Motor)

Engine revolution rotates the pump shaft via the universal joint.
Being engaged with each other, the pump shaft and the cylinder block (1) in the pump rotate together.
With the speed control pedal in the neutral position, the swashplate (2) in the pump is at right angles to the pump
pistons.
The pump pistons rotate with the pump cylinder block (1) without reciprocating motion.
At this time, since the pump pistons do not generate pressure, no pressure is transmitted to the motor pistons,
thus causing neither rotation of the motor cylinder block (4) nor that of the motor shaft engaged with it.
Thus the machine is stationary.
9Y1210595TXM0005US0

2-M4

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM TRANSAXLE
Forward

(1) Cylinder Block (Pump) (5) Lubricating Orifice (8) Transaxle Case (11) Charge Relief Valve
(2) Swashplate (6) Check Valve (Forward) (9) Oil Strainer (12) Filter Cartridge
(3) Piston (7) By-pass Valve (10) Check Valve (Reverse) (13) Charge Pump
(4) Cylinder Block (Motor)

Stepping on the speed control pedal to the forward position inclines the HST trunnion arm, causing the pump
swashplate (2) to incline as shown in the figure.
The pump pistons rotate with the pump cylinder block (1) while reciprocating.
At this time, the pump pistons generate pressure by reciprocating motion. The pressure generated is transmitted
to the motor pistons (Port B - Port D).
Pressure from the port D thrusts the motor pistons to the surface of the inclined thrust ball bearing, causing them
to slide on the inclined surface.
This causes the motor cylinder block (4) and the motor shaft engaged with it to rotate.
This causes the machine to move forward. The inclination of the pump swashplate (2) determines the motor shaft
speed.
9Y1210595TXM0006US0

2-M5

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM TRANSAXLE
Reverse

(1) Cylinder Block (Pump) (5) Lubricating Orifice (8) Transaxle Case (11) Charge Relief Valve
(2) Swashplate (6) Check Valve (Forward) (9) Oil Strainer (12) Filter Cartridge
(3) Piston (7) By-pass Valve (10) Check Valve (Reverse) (13) Charge Pump
(4) Cylinder Block (Motor)

Stepping on the speed control pedal to the reverse position inclines the HST trunnion arm in the direction opposite
to that at moving forward, causing the pump swashplate (2) to incline as shown in the figure.
The pump pistons rotate with the pump cylinder block (1) while reciprocating.
At this time, the pump pistons generate pressure by reciprocating motion. The pressure generated is transmitted
to the motor pistons (Port A - Port C).
Pressure from the port C thrusts the motor pistons to the surface of the inclined thrust ball bearing, causing them
to slide on the inclined surface.
This causes the motor cylinder block (4) and the motor shaft engaged with it to rotate.
This causes the machine to move reverse. The inclination of the pump swashplate (2) determines the motor shaft
speed.
9Y1210595TXM0007US0

2-M6

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM TRANSAXLE

(4) Charge Pump


The charge pump revolves in combination with pump
shaft to draw oil from the transaxle case, and feed oil to
the charge circuit.
The charge pump is necessary to make up for
leakage from the pump and motor, preventing system.
Factory 0.31 to 0.50 MPa
Charge relief pressure specifica- 3.1 to 5.1 kgf/cm2
tion 44 to 72 psi

Condition
• Engine Speed: Rated speed
• Oil Temperature: 50 °C (122 °F)
(1) Internal Snap Ring (5) Spring (Charge Relief Valve)
(2) Oil Seal (6) Steel Ball
(3) O-ring (Charge Relief valve)
(4) Charge Pump Housing
9Y1210595TXM0008US0

(5) By-pass Valve


Normally, when the engine is stopped, the pump
shaft and pump cylinder block engaged with it do not
rotate. Thus, the motor shaft does not rotate.
However, pressing the by-pass valve in the center
section permits moving the machine with human power
while the engine is stopped. The following paragraphs
describe this mechanism:
Pressing the by-pass valve connects the forward and
reverse loops in the center section. This allows oil to flow
between the forward and reverse loops through the
by-pass valve to rotate only the motor cylinder block.
This means that pressing the by-pass valve while the
engine is stopped, that is, while the pump shaft is not
rotating, permits rotating the motor shaft engaged with
the motor cylinder block.
(1) By-pass Spring (3) By-pass Plug
(2) By-pass Spool
9Y1210595TXM0009US0

2-M7

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM TRANSAXLE

(6) Control Linkage

(1) Speed Change Pedal (3) Speed Change Plate (5) Neutral Spring (6) Speed Control Arm
(2) Speed Change Rod (4) Neutral Arm

The speed change pedal (1) and the trunnion arm of variable swashplate are linked with the speed change rod
(2), speed change plate (3) and the speed control arm (6). As the front of the pedal is depressed, the swashplate
rotates and forward travelling speed increases. Depressing the rear end increases reverse speed.
The speed control arm (6) is returned to neutral position by the neutral arm (4) and the tension of neutral spring
(5). At the same time, the swashplate is returned to neutral, when the pedal is released.
9Y1210595TXM0010US0

2-M8

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM TRANSAXLE

[2] MOWER PTO SYSTEM


(1) Mower PTO Clutch
The mower PTO clutch is equipped with mechanical
independent clutches of wet multi-plates type.
The PTO shaft (1) is engaged with the spline boss
(3).
The clutch case (5) is engaged with the 24T gear (6).
Normally, spring (8) tension pushes the spline boss
(3) in the PTO clutch toward the front side of the
machine, which creates clearance between clutch disc
and friction plate (4), causing no friction.
Thus, no driving power is transmitted between spline
boss (3) and clutch case (5), that is, no driving power is
transmitted to the PTO shaft (1).
(1) PTO Shaft (6) 24T Gear
(2) Clutch Lever (7) 19T-2 Gear
(3) Spline Boss (8) Spring
(4) Clutch Disc and Friction (9) Brake Disc and Friction Plate
Plate (10) Thrust Collar
(5) Clutch Case
9Y1210595TXM0011US0
PTO "Engaged"
When the PTO lever is set at the "Engaged"
position, the clutch lever (2) connected to the PTO lever
via a link mechanism rotates to the rear side of the
machine.
The clutch lever pushes the spline boss (3) toward
the rear side of the machine via the thrust collar (10),
which eliminates the clearance between the clutch disc
and friction plate (4), causing friction necessary to
transmit driving power.
This allows driving power to be transmitted as
follows:
19T-2 Gear (7) → 24T Gear (6) → Clutch Case (5)
→ Spline Boss (3) → PTO Shaft (1).
(1) PTO Shaft (6) 24T Gear
(2) Clutch Lever (7) 19T-2 Gear
(3) Spline Boss (8) Spring
(4) Clutch Disc and Friction (9) Brake Disc and Friction Plate
Plate (10) Thrust Collar
(5) Clutch Case
9Y1210595TXM0012US0

2-M9

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM TRANSAXLE
PTO "Disengaged"
When the PTO lever is set at the "Disengaged"
position, the clutch lever (2) connected to the PTO lever
via a link mechanism rotates to the front side of the
machine.
Spring (8) tension pushes the spline boss (3) toward
the front side of the machine, which creates clearance
between the clutch disc and friction plate (4), causing no
friction.
This eliminates the clearance between brake discs
and friction plate (9), causing friction.
Driving power to the PTO shaft (1) is thus shut off
and brake engages to prevent the PTO shaft (1) from
free-spinning.
(1) PTO Shaft (6) 24T Gear
(2) Clutch Lever (7) 19T-2 Gear
(3) Spline Boss (8) Spring
(4) Clutch Disc and Friction (9) Brake Disc and Friction Plate
Plate (10) Thrust Collar
(5) Clutch Case
9Y1210595TXM0013US0

2-M10

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


SERVICING

CONTENTS

1. TROUBLESHOOTING.................................................................................................................2-S1
2. SERVICING SPECIFICATIONS ..................................................................................................2-S3
3. TIGHTENING TORQUES............................................................................................................2-S5
4. CHEKING, DISASSEMBLING AND SERVICING........................................................................2-S6
[1] CHECKING AND ADJUSTING..............................................................................................2-S6
(1) HST Speed Change System ...........................................................................................2-S6
(2) HST Charge Pressure .....................................................................................................2-S7
[2] PREPARATION ...................................................................................................................2-S10
(1) Separating Transaxle ....................................................................................................2-S10
(2) Separating Hydrostatic Transmission............................................................................2-S17
[3] DISASSEMBLING AND ASSEMBLING ..............................................................................2-S21
(1) Hydrostatic Transmission ..............................................................................................2-S21
(2) Transaxle Case .............................................................................................................2-S24
(3) PTO Clutch ....................................................................................................................2-S33
[4] SERVICING .........................................................................................................................2-S38
(1) Hydrostatic Transmission ..............................................................................................2-S38
(2) Transaxle Case .............................................................................................................2-S40

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM TRANSAXLE

1. TROUBLESHOOTING
Reference
Symptom Probable Cause Solution
Page
System Will Not Oil level is low Fill oil to proper level G-9,
Operate in Either 2-S12
Direction Control linkage damaged Repair control linkage 2-S6,
(Speed change pedal to speed control arm) 2-S16
Charge pressure is too Oil filter cartridge Replace oil filter G-37
low clogged cartridge
Charge pump Replace charge pump 2-S21
damaged
Charge relief valve Repair or replace 2-S21
damaged charge relief valve
Check valve damaged Replace check valve 2-S22
By-pass valve damaged Replace by-pass 2-S22
valve
HST component parts damaged Replace HST 2-S21
assembly
Vibration and Noise Oil level is low Fill oil to proper level G-9,
2-S12
Control linkage damaged Repair control linkage 2-S6,
(Speed change pedal to speed control arm) 2-S16
Charge pressure is too Oil filter cartridge Replace oil filter G-37
low clogged cartridge
Charge pump Replace charge pump 2-S21
damaged
Charge relief valve Repair or replace 2-S21
damaged charge relief valve
Check valve damaged Replace check valve 2-S22
By-pass valve damaged Replace by-pass 2-S22
valve
HST component parts damaged Replace HST 2-S21
assembly
Loss of Power Oil level is low Fill oil to proper level G-9,
2-S12
Control linkage damaged Repair control linkage 2-S6,
(Speed change pedal to speed control arm) 2-S16
Charge pressure is too Oil filter cartridge Replace oil filter G-37
low clogged cartridge
Charge pump Replace charge pump 2-S21
damaged
Charge relief valve Repair or replace 2-S21
damaged charge relief valve
Check valve damaged Replace check valve 2-S22
By-pass valve damaged Replace by-pass 2-S22
valve
HST component parts damaged Replace HST 2-S21
assembly

2-S1

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM TRANSAXLE

Reference
Symptom Probable Cause Solution
Page
Oil Over Heat Oil level is low Fill oil to proper level G-9,
2-S12
Excessive machine load Reduce machine load 2-S6,
2-S16
Charge pressure is too Oil filter cartridge Replace oil filter G-37
low clogged cartridge
Charge pump Replace charge pump 2-S21
damaged
Charge relief valve Repair or replace 2-S21
damaged charge relief valve
Machine Will Not Control linkage damaged Repair control linkage 2-S6,
Stop in Neutral (Speed change pedal to speed control arm) 2-S16
Position Improper adjustment of neutral arm holder shaft Adjust 2-S6
System Operates in Control linkage damaged Repair control linkage 2-S6,
One Direction Only (Speed change pedal to speed control arm) 2-S16
Check valve damaged Replace check valve 2-S22
DIFFERENTIAL GEAR SECTION
Reference
Symptom Probable Cause Solution
Page
Excessive or Unusual Improper backlash between 11T bevel gear and Adjust 2-S43
Noise at All Time 17T-13T gear shaft
Improper backlash between differential pinion Adjust 2-S42
and differential side gear
Bearing worn Replace –
Insufficient or improper type of transmission fluid Fill or change G-9,
used 2-S12
Noise while Turning Differential pinions or differential side gears worn Replace 2-S31
or damaged
Bearing worn Replace –

MOWER PTO SECTION


Reference
Symptom Probable Cause Solution
Page
PTO Clutch Slip Improper length of PTO rod spring Adjust 2-S14
PTO rod spring weaken or broken Replace 2-S14
Clutch disc or friction plate excessively worn Replace 2-S24,
2-S40
PTO Shaft Does Not PTO clutch malfunctioning Repair or replace 2-S24,
Rotate 2-S26
Bearing broken Replace 2-S24
PTO Clutch Drags Brake plate excessive worn Replace 2-S24,
2-S41
Clutch spring weaken or broken Replace 2-S24,
2-S40
Deformation of plate Replace 2-S24
9Y1210595TXS0011US0

2-S2

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM TRANSAXLE

2. SERVICING SPECIFICATIONS
HST
Item Factory Specification Allowable Limit
HST Charge Pressure Setting Pressure 0.900 to 1.10 MPa –
(Oil temperature at 50 °C (122 °F)) 9.18 to 11.2 kgf/cm2
131 to 159 psi

PTO CLUTCH
Item Factory Specification Allowable Limit
PTO Clutch Disc Thickness 1.3 to 1.5 mm 1.2 mm
0.052 to 0.059 in. 0.047 in.
Pressure Plate Thickness 1.55 to 1.65 mm 1.50 mm
0.0611 to 0.0649 in. 0.0591 in.
Friction Plate 1 Thickness 1.55 to 1.65 mm 1.50 mm
0.0611 to 0.0649 in. 0.0591 in.
Friction Plate 2 Thickness 0.75 to 0.85 mm 0.70 mm
0.030 to 0.033 in. 0.028 in.
Clutch Spring Free Length 45 mm 42 mm
1.8 in. 1.7 in.
PTO Brake Disc Thickness 3.30 to 3.50 mm 3.00 mm
0.130 to 0.137 in. 0.118 in.
Brake Friction Plate 1 Thickness 1.75 to 1.85 mm 1.60 mm
0.0689 to 0.0728 in. 0.0630 in.
Brake Friction Plate 2 Thickness 0.950 to 1.05 mm 0.80 mm
0.0374 to 0.0413 in. 0.031 in.

2-S3

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM TRANSAXLE
DIFFERENTIAL
Item Factory Specification Allowable Limit
Differential Case to Differential Side Gear Clearance 0.040 to 0.082 mm 0.17 mm
0.0016 to 0.0032 in. 0.0067 in.

• Differential Case Bore I.D. 22.500 to 22.521 mm –


0.88583 to 0.88665 in.

• Differential Side Gear Boss O.D. 22.439 to 22.460 mm –


0.88343 to 0.88425 in.
42T Gear to Differential Side Gear Clearance 0.040 to 0.082 mm 0.17 mm
0.0016 to 0.0032 in. 0.0067 in.

• 42T Gear Boss I.D. 22.500 to 22.521 mm –


0.88583 to 0.88665 in.
Differential Pinion Gear to Differential Clearance 0.025 to 0.055 mm 0.25 mm
Pinion Shaft 0.00099 to 0.0021 in. 0.0098 in.

• Differential Case Bore I.D. 10.000 to 10.015 mm –


0.39370 to 0.39429 in.

• Differential Side Gear Boss O.D. 9.960 to 9.975 mm –


0.3922 to 0.3927 in
Differential Pinion Gear to Differential Side Backlash 0.15 to 0.30 mm –
Gear 0.0059 to 0.011 in.
11T Bevel Gear Shaft to 17T-13T Gear Backlash 0.15 to 0.30 mm –
Shaft 0.0059 to 0.011 in.
9Y1210595TXS0012US0

2-S4

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM TRANSAXLE

3. TIGHTENING TORQUES
Tightening torques of screws, bolts and nuts on the table below are especially specified.
(For general use screws, bolts and nuts: Refer to "5. TIGHTENING TORQUES" on page G-12.)
Item N·m kgf·m lbf·ft
Brake plate mounting screw 34 to 40 3.5 to 4.0 25 to 29
Universal joint mounting screw 9.81 to 11.2 1.00 to 1.15 7.24 to 8.31
Transaxle mounting screw 48 to 55 4.9 to 5.7 36 to 41
Hydrostatic transmission mounting screw 24 to 27 2.4 to 2.8 18 to 20
Hydrostatic transmission mounting screw 2 18 to 20 1.8 to 2.1 13 to 15
Center section mounting hex. socket head screw 18 to 20 1.8 to 2.1 13 to 15
By-pass valve plug 15 1.5 11
Check valve plug 30 3.1 22
PTO clutch assembly mounting screw 18 to 20 1.8 to 2.1 13 to 15
Beam mounting screw 18 to 20 1.8 to 2.1 13 to 15
Transaxle case screw 7.9 to 8.8 0.80 to 0.90 5.8 to 6.5
42T gear mounting screw 9.81 to 11.2 1.00 to 1.15 7.24 to 8.31
9Y1210595TXS0013US0

2-S5

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM TRANSAXLE

4. CHEKING, DISASSEMBLING AND SERVICING


[1] CHECKING AND ADJUSTING
(1) HST Speed Change System
Adjustment of HST Neutral Position
1. Block the front wheels with stoppers, and lift up the rear of
machine with a jack.
2. Remove the left rear wheel.
Remove the cover. [GR1600F, GR1600ID only]
3. Start the engine, and set at approx. 1500 to 3000 min-1 (rpm).
4. Loosen the holder shaft mounting screw (3).
5. Rotate the holder shaft (2) counterclockwise so that the rear
wheels turn forward.
6. Then rotate it clockwise until the rear wheels stop completely.
7. Put a mark on the neutral arm (1). (Position B)
8. Rotate the holder shaft (2) clockwise so that the rear wheels
turn in reverse.
9. Then rotate it counterclockwise until the rear wheels stop
completely.
10. Put a mark on the neutral arm (1). (Position A)
11. Set the holder shaft (2) where it is right in the center between
position A and B and tighten the holder shaft mounting screw
(3) firmly.
This means the hydrostatic transaxle is fully in neutral.
(Position C)

WARNING
• Use buddy system in adjusting the neutral position.
• One of you should sit on the operator's seat, adjust the
engine rpm and step on the speed change pedal. The other
should adjust the neutral position.
(1) Neutral Arm (3) Holder Shaft Mounting Screw
(2) Holder Shaft
9Y1210595TXS0014US0
Speed Change Pedal Restriction
NOTE
• You must adjust this after you complete the adjustment of
neutral.
1. Set the speed change pedal (1) to "NEUTRAL" position, and
apply the parking brake.
2. Check that the pin (3) of speed change pedal lock with the brake
pedal arm (2).
3. If it is improper, adjust the length "A" with the rod end (4) on
speed change rod.
4. Then adjust the length "B" with adjusting nut (6) on speed
change rod (5).
(Reference)
• Length "A": 20 mm (0.79 in.)
• Length "B": 16 to 20 mm (0.63 to 0.78 in.)
(1) Speed Change Pedal (4) Rod End
(2) Brake Pedal Arm (5) Speed Change Rod
(3) Pin (6) Adjusting Nut
9Y1210595TXS0015US0

2-S6

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM TRANSAXLE
Adjusting Maximum Speed
NOTE
• You must adjust this after you complete the adjustment of
neutral.
[Forward]
1. Loose the lock nut (2) of adjusting screw.
2. Adjust the length "A" with the adjusting screw (1).
(Reference)
• Length "A": 12 to 15 mm (0.48 to 0.59 in.)
• Traveling speed: 9.0 to 10 km/h (5.6 to 6.2 mph)
[Reverse]
1. Loose the lock nut (3) of adjusting screw.
2. Adjust the length "B" with the adjusting screw (4).
(Reference)
• Length "B": 12 to 13 mm (0.47 to 0.51 in.)
• Traveling speed: 4.0 to 5.0 km/h (2.5 to 3.1 mph)
(1) Adjusting Screw (3) Lock Nut
(2) Lock Nut (4) Adjusting Screw
9Y1210595TXS0016US0

(2) HST Charge Pressure


[A] GR1600EU, GR1600F
Removing Container
1. Pull the top cover lock lever (2) to open the top cover (1).
2. Set the grass container lift lever (4) in "LEVER LOCK" position.
3. Lift up the rear of the grass container (3).
4. Lift up the whole grass container and remove.
(When attaching)
• Open the top cover (1).
• Set the grass container lift lever (4) in "LEVER LOCK" position.
• Lift the rear end of the grass container (3), set the grass
container (3) onto the frame shaft so that a clearance "L" is
about 0 to 50 mm (0 to 1.9 in.).
• Lock the grass container (3) with the grass container lift lever (4)
in "CONTAINER LOCK" position.
• Close the top cover (1).
(Reference)
• Clearance "L": 0 to 50 mm (0 to 1.9 in.)
(1) Top Cover (3) Grass Container
(2) Top Cover Lock Lever (4) Grass Container Lift Lever
9Y1210595TXS0001US0

2-S7

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM TRANSAXLE
Discharge Duct
1. Remove the filter cover (1).
2. Remove the screws (3) for the discharge duct (2).
3. Disconnect the spring (4) and the coupler (5).
4. Remove the discharge duct (2).
(1) Filter Cover (4) Spring
(2) Discharge Duct (5) Coupler
(3) Screw
9Y1210595TXS0002US0

[B] GR1600ID
Removing the Rear Cover
1. Remove the rear cover (1).
(1) Rear Cover
9Y1210595TXS0077US0

2-S8

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM TRANSAXLE

[C] checking
Checking HST Charge Pressure

CAUTION
• Park the machine on level ground, and apply the parking
brake.
• Adjust HST neutral first.
1. Remove the plug (1) from the hydraulic control valve assembly.
2. Install the gauge hose adaptor, gauge hose and pressure
gauge. Refer to "[2] SPECIAL TOOLS FOR MACHINE" on page
G-56.
3. Start the engine and run engine speed at maximum speed.
4. Read the pressure gauge to measure the HST charge pressure.
5. If the measurement is not within the factory specification, check
the hydraulic control valve and the related hydraulic
components.
0.900 to 1.10 MPa
HST charge pressure Factory specification 9.18 to 11.2 kgf/cm2
131 to 159 psi

Condition
• Engine speed
Maximum
• Oil temperature
50 °C (122 °F)
(1) Plug (3) Gauge Hose
(2) Gauge Hose Adaptor
9Y1210595TXS0006US0

2-S9

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM TRANSAXLE

[2] PREPARATION
(1) Separating Transaxle
Dismounting Mower
1. Refer to "[2] PREPARATION (DISMOUNTING MOWER)" on
page 7-S10.
9Y1210595TXS0017US0

[A] GR1600EU, GR1600F


Removing Container
1. Pull the top cover lock lever (2) to open the top cover (1).
2. Set the grass container lift lever (4) in "LEVER LOCK" position.
3. Lift up the rear of the grass container (3).
4. Lift up the whole grass container and remove.
(When attaching)
• Open the top cover (1).
• Set the grass container lift lever (4) in "LEVER LOCK" position.
• Lift the rear end of the grass container (3), set the grass
container (3) onto the frame shaft so that a clearance "L" is
about 0 to 50 mm (0 to 1.9 in.).
• Lock the grass container (3) with the grass container lift lever (4)
in "CONTAINER LOCK" position.
• Close the top cover (1).
(Reference)
• Clearance "L": 0 to 50 mm (0 to 1.9 in.)
(1) Top Cover (3) Grass Container
(2) Top Cover Lock Lever (4) Grass Container Lift Lever
9Y1210595TXS0001US0

2-S10

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM TRANSAXLE
Discharge Duct
1. Remove the filter cover (1).
2. Remove the screws (3) for the discharge duct (2).
3. Disconnect the spring (4) and the coupler (5).
4. Remove the discharge duct (2).
(1) Filter Cover (4) Spring
(2) Discharge Duct (5) Coupler
(3) Screw
9Y1210595TXS0002US0

Container Base
1. Disconnect the connector (2).
2. Remove the container base (1).
(1) Container Base (2) Connector
9Y1210595TXS0005US0

[B] GR1600ID
Removing the Rear Cover
1. Remove the rear cover (1).
(1) Rear Cover
9Y1210595TXS0077US0

2-S11

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM TRANSAXLE
Draining Transmission Fluid
1. Start the engine. Push the mower lift lever and lower the mower
link.
2. Place an oil pan under the transaxle.
3. Remove the drain plug (2).
4. Remove the stainer (5) to completely drain the transmission
fluid.
5. After draining, clean the strainer (5) and reinstall it.
(When refilling)
• Remove the filling plug with the dipstick and fill the new
transmission fluid to "H" level on the dipstick.
• Start the engine and perform the following operations, However,
absolutely avoid engaging the PTO lever during this operation.
a) Depress the speed change pedal alternately to the forward
side and reverse side in order to move the machine forward
and backward.
b) Rotate the steering wheel to the right and left to turn the
front wheels right and left.
c) Operate the mower lift lever in order to make the mower
deck go up and down.
d) During the operation described above, check to see if no oil
leakage from the transaxle assembly and each hydraulic
pipe is found.
• At least 5 minutes after stopping the engine, check the oil level
again, using the dipstick.
• If the oil level is lower than the "H" level indicated on the
dipstick, fill the oil tank with transmission fluid additionally up to
the "H" level.
• Perform the above-mentioned operation again. And make sure
that the oil level is not low level.
• Disconnect the universal joint of mower deck from the PTO
shaft. Shift the PTO lever to "Engage" position and check to
see if the PTO shaft rotates quickly without abnormal noise.
Next, shift the PTO lever to the "Disengage" position and
check to see if the PTO shaft stops operation quickly without
abnormal noise.
IMPORTANT
• Park the machine on lever ground.
• Use the KUBOTA UDT or SUPER UDT fluid. Use of other
oils may damage the transmission or hydraulic system.
Refer to "4. LUBRICANTS, FUEL AND COOLANT" on page
G-9.
• Do not mix different brand oil together.
2.8 L
Transmission fluid Capacity 0.74 U.S.gals
0.62 lmp.gals

(1) Suction Pipe (6) Boss


(2) Drain Plug (7) Filling Plug with Dipstick
(3) O-ring (Small)
(4) O-ring (Large) H: Highest Level
(5) Strainer L: Lowest Level
9Y1210595TXS0080US0

2-S12

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM TRANSAXLE
Battery

CAUTION
• When disconnecting the battery cables, disconnect the
negative cable from the battery first. When connecting,
connect the positive cable to the battery first.
1. Open the bonnet.
2. Disconnect the negative cable (1) from the battery.
3. Disconnect the positive cable (2) from the battery and remove
the battery (3).
(1) Negative Cable (3) Battery
(2) Positive Cable
9Y1210595ENS0023US0
Seat
1. Remove two snap pins (2), (4).
2. Remove the seat (1) and snap plate (3).
(1) Seat (3) Snap Plate
(2) Snap Pin (4) Snap Pin
9Y1210595TXS0019US0

Fender and Relay


1. Remove the lever grip (1) and cutting height control dial (6).
2. Remove the speed change pedal (7).
3. Remove the seat base (2).
4. Peel the step sheet (8) halfway.
5. Remove the fuel cap (4).
6. Remove the relay stay (9).
7. Disconnect the connectors for the timer relay, grass container
full switch relay, grass container relay and buzzer relay.
8. Remove the fender (5).
(1) Lever Grip (6) Cutting Height Control Dial
(2) Seat Base (7) Speed Change Pedal
(3) Fender Mounting Screw (8) Step Sheet
(4) Fuel Cap (9) Relay Stay
(5) Fender
9Y1210595TXS0020US0

Fuel Tank
1. Drain the fuel.
2. Disconnect the fuel hoses.
3. Remove the fuel tank (1).
(1) Fuel Tank
9Y1210595TXS0021US0

2-S13

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM TRANSAXLE
PTO Rod Spring
1. Remove the two nuts (2) (3) and spring (4).
(When reassembling)
1. Assemble a fuel tank, a seat base and a fender.
2. Setting the PTO lever at "Disengaged" position and lifting the
PTO arm (5) slightly by hands directly, the upper side of PTO
arm (5) and lower nut (6) on the upper side of PTO rod (1) make
contact, and there is no play between them. Keeping this
position, be sure to tighten the two nuts (6) (7) on the upper side
of this PTO rod (1).
3. Assemble temporarily the spring (4) and two nuts (2) (3) to the
PTO rod (1). After this, set the PTO lever at "Engaged"
position, and then be sure to tighten two nuts (2) (3) on the lower
side of PTO rod (1) so that the spring length "L2" reaches the
specified value.
IMPORTANT
• After completing above assembling / adjustment, repeat
the motion several times to set the PTO lever at
"Disengaged" and "Engaged" position. Then, finally set the
PTO lever at "Engaged" position. Be sure to check that the
upper side of PTO arm (5) and the lower sides of two nuts
(6) (7) on the upper side of PTO rod (1) are making no
contact.
(When reassembling)
68 mm
Spring length "L2" Factory specification
2.7 in.

(Reference)
• Length "L1": 115 to 118 mm (4.53 to 4.64 in.)
• Length "L3": 38.0 to 40.0 mm (1.50 to 1.57 in.)
(1) PTO Rod (6) Nut
(2) Nut (7) Nut
(3) Nut
(4) Spring (A) "Disengaged" Position
(5) PTO Arm (B) "Engaged" Position
9Y1210595TXS0022US0

2-S14

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM TRANSAXLE
Beam
1. Disconnect the connector from the PTO switch (1).
2. Remove the spring (2) from the PTO lever (3).
3. Remove the PTO rod.
4. Remove the filling pipe (4).
5. Remove the hose clamp (7) of breather hose (6).
6. Remove the beam (5).
(When reassembling)
• After assembling the beam, fix the breather hose (6) to the
beam (5) with the hose clamp horizontally along the beam (5).
(1) PTO Switch (5) Beam
(2) Spring (6) Breather Hose
(3) PTO Lever (7) Hose clamp
(4) Filling Pipe
9Y1210595TXS0023US0

Brake Rod
1. Disconnect the brake rod 1 (6).
2. Remove the lock nut (1), plain washers (2) and brake spring (3).
3. Remove the brake plate (5).
4. Remove the brake rod 2 (4) and brake rod 1 (6).
(When reassembling)
• After assembling the brake rod 1, 2 (4), (6) and brake spring
(3), be sure to adjust the brake pedal free travel. (Refer to
"4. CHECKING, DISASSEMBLING AND SERVICING" on
page 3-S4.)

34 to 40 N·m
Brake plate mounting
Tightening torque 3.5 to 4.0 kgf·m
screw
25 to 29 lbf·ft

(1) Lock Nut (4) Brake Rod 2


(2) Plain Washer (5) Brake Plate
(3) Brake Spring (6) Brake Rod 1
9Y1210595TXS0024US0

2-S15

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM TRANSAXLE
Speed Control Plate
1. Remove the split pin (2), and disconnect the speed change
plate (1) and speed control arm (3).
2. Separate the speed change plate (1) and speed change rod (4).
IMPORTANT
• After assembling the speed change plate (1) and speed
change rod (4), be sure to adjust the speed change pedal
restriction. (Refer to "[1] CHECKING AND ADJUSTING" on
page 2-S6.)
(1) Speed Change Plate (4) Speed Change Rod
(2) Split Pin (5) Lock Nut
(3) Speed Control Arm
9Y1210595TXS0025US0

Universal Joint and Rear Wheel


1. Remove the universal joint mounting screw (1).
2. Disconnect the universal joint (2).
3. Block the front wheels with stopper, and lift up the frame.
4. Remove the retaining ring (3) and remove the rear wheel (4).
(When reassembling)
• Apply grease to the splines of the universal joint.
9.81 to 11.2 N·m
Universal joint mounting
Tightening torque 1.00 to 1.15 kgf·m
screw
7.24 to 8.31 lbf·ft

(1) Universal Joint Mounting Screw (3) Retaining Ring


(2) Universal Joint (4) Rear Wheel
9Y1210595TXS0026US0

Separating Transmission
1. Remove the transaxle mounting screws (2).
2. Separate the transaxle (1) from the frame.
(When reassembling)
48 to 55 N·m
Transaxle mounting screw
Tightening torque 4.9 to 5.7 kgf·m
(2)
36 to 41 lbf·ft

(1) Transaxle (2) Transaxle Mounting Screw


9Y1210595TXS0027US0

2-S16

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM TRANSAXLE

(2) Separating Hydrostatic Transmission


Speed Control Arm, Neutral Spring, Cooling Fan and Others
1. Remove the neutral spring (2).
2. Remove the speed control arm (1).
3. Remove the cooling fan (3).
4. Remove the breather hoses (4).
(When reassembling)
NOTE
• When reinstall the set screw (7) (for the speed control arm),
apply the liquid lock (Three Bond 1324 or its equivalent) to
the screw.
• Before reconnecting the breather hoses to breather ports, clean
the breather ports and the inside of breather hose.
• When reconnecting the breather hoses to breather ports, set the
hose clamp at 1 to 2 mm (0.04 to 0.07 in.) from the hose end.
• Fix the breather hose (4) with a cord clamp (9) so that the
breather hose (4) does not contact with the cooling fan shaft (8).
In this case, wind the cord clamp (9) around the breather hose
(4) in the direction indicated by the arrow mark shown in the
figure.
• Fix the breather hose (4) on the suction pipe (6) with the clamp
as shown in the figure (A).
18 to 20 N·m
Set screw for speed
Tightening torque 1.8 to 2.1 kgf·m
control arm
13 to 15 lbf·ft

(1) Speed Control Arm (7) Set Screw


(2) Neutral Spring (8) Cooling Fan Shaft
(3) Cooling Fan (9) Cord Clamp
(4) Breather Hose
(5) Neutral Arm Holder (A) Fix the breather hose on the
(6) Suction Pipe 1 suction pipe 1
9Y1210595TXS0028US0

2-S17

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM TRANSAXLE
Suction Filter Case
1. Remove the hose (3).
2. Remove the suction filter case (1) with the suction pipe 2 (2).
3. Remove the suction pipe 2 (2) from the suction filter case (1).
4. Remove the boss (7) and strainer (6) from the suction filter case
(1).
(When reassembling)
• After cleaning the strainer (6), install it in the suction filter case
(1).
• Install the boss (7) that sets two O-rings (5) in the suction filter
case (1).
• After setting the O-ring (4) in the suction pipe 2 (2), install the
suction pipe 2 (2) in the suction filter case (1).
• After setting the O-ring (9) in the transaxle case (8), install the
suction filter case (1) in the transaxle case (8).
7.9 to 8.8 N·m
Suction pipe 2 mounting
0.80 to 0.90 kgf·m
screw
5.8 to 6.5 lbf·ft
Tightening torque
7.9 to 8.8 N·m
Suction filter case mounting
0.80 to 0.90 kgf·m
screw
5.8 to 6.5 lbf·ft

(1) Suction Filter Case (6) Strainer


(2) Suction Pipe 2 (7) Boss
(3) Hose (8) Transaxle Case
(4) O-ring (Small) (9) O-ring
(5) O-ring (Large)
9Y1210595TXS0029US0

2-S18

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM TRANSAXLE
Neutral Arm Holder and Filter Bracket
1. Remove the neutral arm holder mounting screws (M8) (4).
2. Remove the filter bracket (2) with the neutral arm holder (3).
3. Remove the charge pipe (6).
(When reassembling)
NOTE
• Apply the oil to two O-rings (5) on the charge pipe (6). Insert
the charge pipe (6) straight into the charge port (7).
Be careful not to damage the O-ring. Next, insert the filter
bracket (2) straight into the charge pipe (6).
(1) Neutral Arm (5) O-ring
(2) Filter Bracket (6) Charge Pipe
(3) Neutral Arm Holder (7) Charge Port
(4) Neutral Arm Holder Mounting Screw
(M8)
9Y1210595TXS0081US0

2-S19

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM TRANSAXLE
Brake Assembly
1. Remove the brake assembly (1).
2. Remove the external snap ring (2). And pull out the brake drum
(3).
(When reassembling)
• Apply liquid gasket (Three Bond 1206D or equivalent) to joint
face of brake assembly and hydrostatic transmission thinly.
• Tighten the brake assembly mounting screws (4) while pushing
up the brake arm lever (5) by the hand.
7.9 to 8.8 N·m
Brake Assembly Mounting
Tightening torque 0.80 to 0.90 kgf·m
Screw
5.8 to 6.5 lbf·ft

(1) Brake Assembly (4) Brake Assembly Mounting Screw


(2) External Snap Ring (5) Brake Arm Lever
(3) Brake Drum
9Y1210595TXS0031US0

Hydrostatic Transmission Assembly


1. Remove the hydrostatic transmission assembly (1).
(When reassembling)
• Apply the liquid gasket (Three Bond 1206D or equivalent) to
joint face of the hydrostatic transmission assembly (1).
• Cover the splines of front drive shaft with thin tape to protect the
sealing lip of the oil seal.
NOTE
• When reassembling the hydrostatic transmission
assembly, insert the drain pipe (3) in the hole (2) surely so
as not to drop out it.
24 to 27 N·m
Hydrostatic transmission
Tightening torque 2.4 to 2.8 kgf·m
mounting screw
18 to 20 lbf·ft
18 to 20 N·m
Tightening torque Oil pressure switch 1.8 to 2.1 kgf·m
13 to 15 lbf·ft

(1) Hydrostatic Transmission Assembly (4) Hydrostatic Transmission Mounting


(2) Hole Screw 2
(3) Drain Pipe
9Y1210595TXS0032US0

2-S20

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM TRANSAXLE

[3] DISASSEMBLING AND ASSEMBLING


(1) Hydrostatic Transmission
15T Gear, 34T Gear and Bevel Gear Shaft
1. Remove the external snap ring (4). And pull out the 15T gear (1)
and 34T gear (2).
2. Remove the bevel gear shaft (3).
(1) 15T Gear (4) External Snap Ring
(2) 34T Gear (5) Shim
(3) Bevel Gear Shaft
9Y1210595TXS0033US0

Charge Pump Housing and Charge Relief Valve


1. Remove the charge pump housing (1).
2. Remove the spring (5) and the steel ball (6).
3. Remove the O-ring (4) from the charge pump housing (1).
4. Remove the internal snap ring (2) and the oil seal (3).
NOTE
• When removing the oil seal (3), be careful not to damage
the charge pump housing (1).
• Be careful not to damage the O-ring (4).
(1) Charge Pump Housing (5) Spring
(2) Internal Snap Ring (6) Steel Ball
(3) Oil Seal (7) Charge Relief Valve
(4) O-ring
9Y1210595TXS0082US0

Gerotor
1. Remove the gerotor (1).
2. Draw out the drive pin (2) on the pump shaft (3).
(When reassembling)
• Apply clean transmission oil to the both side of gerotors.
(1) Gerotor (3) Pump Shaft
(2) Drive Pin
9Y1210595TXS0035US0

2-S21

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM TRANSAXLE
Center Section
1. Remove the center section mounting hex. socket head screws.
2. Tap the center section (1) with soft hammer and separate the
center section (1) from the HST housing (2).
(When reassembling)
• Cover the splines of each shaft with thin tape to protect the
sealing lip of the oil seals.
• Place a new gasket on the HST housing.
NOTE
• Be careful not to damage the surface of cylinder blocks,
pistons and center section.
18 to 20 N·m
Center section mounting
Tightening torque 1.8 to 2.1 kgf·m
hex. socket head screw
13 to 15 lbf·ft

(1) Center Section (2) HST Housing


9Y1210595TXS0083US0
By-pass Valve
1. Remove the plug (4) and draw out the by-pass spool (2) and
spring (1).
(When reassembling)
• Be careful not to damage the O-ring (3) on the plug (4).
15 N·m
Tightening torque By-pass valve plug 1.5 kgf·m
11 lbf·ft

(1) Spring (3) O-ring


(2) By-pass Spool (4) Plug
9Y1210595TXS0084US0
Check Valve
1. Remove the plugs (1), (8).
2. Draw out the springs (3), (6).
3. Draw out the check valve (4) and ball check (5).
(When reassembling)
• Be careful not to damage the O-rings (2), (7) on the plugs (1),
(8).
30 N·m
Tightening torque Check valve plug 3.1 kgf·m
22 lbf·ft

(1) Plug (5) Ball Check


(2) O-ring (6) Spring
(3) Spring (7) O-ring
(4) Check Valve (8) Plug
9Y1210595TXS0085US0

2-S22

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM TRANSAXLE
Cylinder Block Assembly and Thrust Ball Bearing
1. Remove the cylinder block assembly (pump side) (1), spring (2)
and washer (3).
2. Remove the cylinder block assembly (motor side) (5).
3. Remove the thrust ball bearing (4).
(When reassembling)
• Apply clean transmission oil to thrust ball bearing, cylinder block
and piston.
NOTE
• Be careful not to damage the surface of cylinder blocks and
pistons.
(1) Cylinder Block Assembly (4) Thrust Ball Bearing
(Pump Side) (5) Cylinder Block Assembly
(2) Spring (Motor Side)
(3) Washer
9Y1210595TXS0086US0
Swashplate, Pump Shaft and Motor Shaft
1. Remove the swashplate (2) and thrust ball bearing (1) from the
HST housing.
2. Remove the internal snap ring (5), and tap out the pump shaft
(3) and oil seal (4).
3. Remove the internal snap ring (6) and the oil seal (7).
4. Remove the internal snap ring (8) and tap out the motor shaft
(10).
NOTE
• When removing the oil seal (7), be careful not to damage
the HST housing.
(When reassembling)
• Apply clean transmission oil to thrust ball bearing (1).
(1) Thrust Ball Bearing (6) Internal Snap Ring
(2) Swashplate (7) Oil Seal
(3) Pump Shaft (8) Internal Snap Ring
(4) Oil Seal (9) External Snap Ring
(5) Internal Snap Ring (10) Motor Shaft
9Y1210595TXS0087US0
Cradle Bearing, Slot Guide and Trunnion Arm
1. Remove the slot guide (2) and trunnion arm (3).
2. Remove the cradle bearings (1) from the HST housing.
(When reassembling)
• Apply clean transmission oil to the cradle bearings (1) and
trunnion arm.
• Fasten down the cradle bearing to the HST housing.
(1) Cradle Bearing (3) Trunnion Arm
(2) Slot Guide
9Y1210595TXS0041US0

2-S23

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM TRANSAXLE

(2) Transaxle Case


Disassembling PTO Clutch Assembly
1. Remove the PTO cover assembly (1) with the brake disc and
friction plate, PTO clutch assembly (3) and 24T gear (2) from
the transaxle case.
2. Remove the ball bearing (4) from the transaxle case.
3. Remove the 24T gear (2), PTO clutch assembly (3), brake disc
and friction plate (5) from PTO shaft (6).
4. While pressing the PTO clutch assembly (3), turn the clutch
case (7) clockwise. Then, separate the clutch case (7) and the
spline boss (12) with clutch disc and friction plate (13).
5. Remove the thrust needle bearing (8), thrust collar (9), collar
(10) and spring (11).
6. Remove the external snap ring (14), clutch disc and friction
plate (13) from the spline boss (12).
(When reassembling)
18 to 20 N·m
PTO cover assembly
Tightening torque 1.8 to 2.1 kgf·m
mounting screw
13 to 15 lbf·ft

(1) PTO Cover Assembly (8) Thrust Needle Bearing


(2) 24T Gear (9) Thrust Collar
(3) PTO Clutch Assembly (10) Collar
(4) Ball Bearing (11) Spring
(5) Brake Disc and Friction Plate (12) Spline Boss
(6) PTO Shaft (13) Clutch Disc and Friction Plate
(7) Clutch Case (14) External Snap Ring
9Y1210595TXS0042US0

2-S24

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM TRANSAXLE
Disassembling PTO Cover Assembly
1. Pull out the PTO shaft (1) from PTO clutch cover (5) until
external snap ring (3) touches clutch lever (4).
2. Tap out the PTO shaft (1) while opening the external snap ring
(3) with external snap ring pliers.
3. Remove the thrust collar (2) from PTO shaft (1).
4. Remove the ball bearing (6) and oil seal (7) from the PTO clutch
cover (5).
(1) PTO Shaft (5) PTO Clutch Cover
(2) Thrust Collar (6) Ball Bearing
(3) External Snap Ring (7) Oil Seal
(4) Clutch Lever
9Y1210595TXS0043US0

2-S25

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM TRANSAXLE
Assembling PTO Clutch Assembly
NOTE
• When assembling the PTO clutch assembly to the transaxle
assembly installed in the machine, refer to "(3) PTO Clutch"
on page 2-S33.
1. Place the transaxle case so that the front side faces upward.
And fix it lightly.
2. Install the ball bearing (1) with the sealed face inside as shown
in the figure.
3. Install the 24T gear (6) in the clutch case (7). Install the collar
(4) in the clutch case (7), noting its direction.
4. Install the thrust needle bearing (5), thrust collar (3) and PTO
shaft (2) in the clutch case (7) as shown in the figure.
5. Install the clutch disc and friction plate (9) and external snap ring
(8) in the spline boss (10).
6. Install the spring (11) in the PTO shaft (2). Install the spline boss
(10) which assembles the clutch disc and friction plate in PTO
shaft (2).
7. Turn the clutch case (7) clockwise while pushing spline boss
(10), and lock the spline boss (10) which assembles clutch disc
and friction plate to the clutch case (7).
8. Install the brake discs (13), (15) and friction plate (12), (14) in
the spline boss (10).
IMPORTANT
• Do not change the arrangement of the brake discs (13), (15)
and brake friction plates (12), (14).
NOTE
• Thickness of the brake friction plate 1 (12) is greater than
that of the friction plate 2 (14).
• The brake disc 1 (15) has the facing only in one side.
(1) Ball Bearing (9) Clutch Disc and Friction Plate
(2) PTO Shaft (10) Spline Boss
(3) Thrust Collar (11) Spring
(4) Collar (12) Brake Friction Plate 1
(5) Thrust Needle Bearing (13) Brake Disc
(6) 24T Gear (14) Brake Friction Plate 2
(7) Clutch Case (15) Brake Disc 1
(8) External Snap Ring
(To be continued)

2-S26

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM TRANSAXLE
(Continued)
1. Remove the PTO shaft from the spline boss carefully.
2. Install the PTO clutch assembly (18) which assembles the 24T
gear, spline boss, brake disc and friction plate in the transaxle
case.
NOTE
• Align the tongues (16) of the brake friction plate with the
grooves (17) of transaxle case.
3. Install the PTO cover assembly (19) in the transaxle case while
inserting the PTO shaft in the spline boss.
NOTE
• Apply the liquid gasket (Three Bond 1206D or equivalent) to
joint face of PTO cover and transaxle case.
• Install the PTO cover assembly (19) while you make sure
that tongues (16) of brake friction plate do not come off
from the grooves (17) of transaxle case. (See "A" in the
figure.)
• Tighten the PTO cover assembly mounting screws evenly.
4. After installing the PTO cover assembly (19) in the transaxle
case, push up the PTO lever, and ensure that the PTO shaft
rotates smoothly.
18 to 20 N·m
PTO cover assembly
Tightening torque 1.8 to 2.1 kgf·m
mounting screw
13 to 15 lbf·ft

(16) Tongue (18) PTO Clutch Assembly


(17) Groove (19) PTO Cover Assembly
9Y1210595TXS0078US0

Beam
1. Remove the beam (1) from the transaxle case.
(When reassembling)
18 to 20 N·m
Tightening torque Beam mounting screw 1.8 to 2.1 kgf·m
13 to 15 lbf·ft

(1) Beam
9Y1210595TXS0045US0

2-S27

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM TRANSAXLE
Transaxle Case
1. Remove the transaxle case screws (2).
2. Separate the front side of transaxle case (1).
(When reassembling)
• Apply the liquid gasket (Three Bond 1206D or its equivalent)
without any break along the sealing groove on the front side of
transaxle case: the coating width and height should be 2 mm
(0.078 in.) and 1.5 mm (0.059 in.), respectively.
• Also apply the liquid gasket on the grooves around holes "A"
shown in the figure.
NOTE
• Apply the liquid gasket thinly to both front and rear sides
only in the oil seal receiving part "B" of rear axle. Be sure
to remove extra liquid gasket therefrom if present.
(1) Transaxle Case (Front Side) F: Front Side
(2) Transaxle Case Screw R: Rear Side
(3) Transaxle Case (Rear Side) A: Liquid Gasket Application
Portion
B: Oil Seal Receiving Part
(To be continued)

2-S28

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM TRANSAXLE
(Continued)
NOTE
• Do not apply the liquid gasket on the oil passage "A"
shown in the figure.
• Install the transaxle case screws (2) in the direction shown
in figure.
• Tighten all screws by the hand. Then, tighten the screws
located at the circled positions "B" first with tightening
torques. Next, tighten the remaining screws with tightening
torque.
9.81 to 11.2 N·m
Tightening torque Transaxle case screw 1.00 to 1.15 kgf·m
7.24 to 8.31 lbf·ft

(1) Transaxle Case (Front Side) F: Front Side


(2) Transaxle Case Screw R: Rear Side
(3) Transaxle Case (Rear Side) A: Oil Passage
B: Screws Which Tightened First
with Tightening Torque
9Y1210595TXS0046US0

2-S29

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM TRANSAXLE
Input Shaft, 19T-2 Gear and 17T-13T Gear Shaft
1. Remove the input shaft (1).
2. Remove the intermediate shaft (2) and 19T-2 gear (3) with
collars (6) and needle bearing (7).
3. Remove the 17T-13T gear shaft (4).
NOTE
• Install the two external snap rings (5) on intermediate shaft
(2) by shifting each mating portion by 180 degrees.
(1) Input Shaft (5) External Snap Ring
(2) Intermediate Shaft (6) Collar
(3) 19T-2 Gear (7) Needle Bearing
(4) 17T-13T Gear Shaft
9Y1210595TXS0047US0

Rear Differential Gear, Drive Shaft and 11T Gear Shaft (RH, LH)
1. Remove the rear differential gear assembly (2), 11T gear shafts
(1), (6) and drive shaft (5).
2. Remove the external snap ring (3) and washer (4) from drive
shaft (5).
(1) 11TGear Shaft (LH) (4) Washer
(2) Rear Differential Gear Assembly (5) Drive Shaft
(3) External Snap Ring (6) 11T Gear Shaft (RH)
9Y1210595TXS0048US0

2-S30

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM TRANSAXLE
Rear Differential Gear, Drive Shaft and 11T Gear Shaft (RH, LH)
1. Remove the rear differential gear assembly (3), 11T gear shafts
(1), (7) and drive shaft (5).
2. Remove the external snap ring (8) and bearing (4) from drive
shaft (5).
(When reassembling)
• When installing the bushes (2), (6) in the rear side of transaxle
case, direct the splits of bush "A" to the front side.
(1) 11TGear Shaft (LH) (6) Bush
(2) Bush (7) 11T Gear Shaft (RH)
(3) Rear Differential Gear Assembly (8) External Snap Ring
(4) Bearing
(5) Drive Shaft A: Split of Bush
9Y1210595TXS0049US0

Rear Differential Gear Assembly


1. Remove the 42T gear mounting screws (1).
2. Remove the 42T gear (2) and differential side gear (3).
3. Remove the differential pinion shaft (6).
4. Remove the differential pinion gears (5), differential side gear
(7) and shims (4).
NOTE
• Arrange the parts to know their original position.
(When reassembling)
• Apply molybdenum disulfide (Three Bond 1901 or equivalent) to
the inner circumferential surface of differential pinion gears (5),
differential side gears (3), (7) and shims (4).
9.81 to 11.2 N·m
Tightening torque 42T gear mounting screw 1.00 to 1.15 kgf·m
7.24 to 8.31 lbf·ft

(1) 42T Gear Mounting Screw (5) Differential Pinion Gear


(2) 42T Gear (6) Differential Pinion Shaft
(3) Differential Side Gear (7) Differential Side Gear
(4) Shim
9Y1210595TXS0050US0

2-S31

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM TRANSAXLE
Rear Axle
1. Remove the rear axle (1).
2. Remove the oil seal (2) from the rear axle (1)
(1) Rear Axle (2) Oil Seal
9Y1210595TXS0051US0

2-S32

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM TRANSAXLE

(3) PTO Clutch


Dismounting Mower
1. Refer to "[2] PREPARATION (DISMOUNTING MOWER)" on
page 7-S10.
9Y1210595TXS0017US0
Draining Transmission Fluid
1. Refer to G-39.
9Y1210595TXS0053US0
Separating PTO Cover Assembly with PTO Clutch Assembly
1. Remove the two nuts (4), (5) and spring (6).
2. Pull out the PTO cover assembly (1) with PTO clutch (10)
slowly.
NOTE
• If PTO cover assembly (1) sticks to the transaxle case (7),
move the PTO arm (2) up and down.
IMPORTANT
• When pulling out the PTO cover assembly (1) with PTO
clutch, check if any parts remain inside the transaxle case
(7).
(1) PTO Cover Assembly (7) Transaxle Case
(2) PTO Arm (8) Ball Bearing
(3) PTO Rod (9) 24T Gear
(4) Nut (10) PTO Clutch
(5) Nut (11) Brake Disc and Friction Plate
(6) Spring
9Y1210595TXS0054US0

2-S33

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM TRANSAXLE
 Reinstalling PTO Cover Assembly with PTO Clutch to the Transaxle Assembly installed in the machine.
9Y1210595TXS0055US0
Pre-Assembly PTO Cover Assembly
1. Separate the PTO cover assembly (1) and PTO clutch
assembly (3) with brake disc and friction plate (2).
2. Install the PTO cover assembly (1) in the template (7) with the
six flange bolts and nuts (6).
3. Apply there dots of liquid gasket (Three Bond 1206D or
equivalent) on the places "A" shown in figure of the brake
friction plate 1 (4).
NOTE
• Thickness of the brake friction plate 1 (4) is greater than
that of the brake friction plate 2 (5).
4. Then, attach the brake friction plate 1 to the PTO cover
assembly (1) installed in the template (7).
5. After you make sure that the brake friction plate 1 (4) is fixed to
the PTO cover assembly (1), remove the template (7) from the
PTO cover assembly (1).
IMPORTANT
• After attaching the brake friction plate 1 (4) to the PTO
cover assembly (1), do not try to move the PTO arm.
(1) PTO Cover Assembly (6) Flange Bolt and Nut
(2) Brake Disc and Friction Plate (7) Template
(3) PTO Clutch Assembly
(4) Brake Friction Plate 1 A: Liquid Gasket Application
(5) Brake Friction Plate 2 Portion
9Y1210595TXS0088US0

2-S34

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM TRANSAXLE
Installation of PTO Cover Assembly with PTO Clutch Assembly
1. Clean the mating surface of the transaxle case (3) and PTO
cover assembly.
2. Tighten the stud bolts (1) at three locations shown in figure by
hand.
NOTE
• You must tighten the stud bolt (1) with the shorter thread
into the transaxle case (3).
3. Install the ball bearing (2) with the sealed face inside as shown
in figure.
4. Apply the liquid gasket (Three Bond 1206D or equivalent) along
the sealing groove (5) on the PTO cover assembly (4).
5. Install the brake discs, brake friction plate 2 (6), PTO clutch
assembly (7) and 24T gear (8) to the PTO cover assembly (4).
6. Align the tongues of brake friction plate 1 and 2. (See (A) in
figure.)
NOTE
• After aligning the tongues of brake friction plate 1 and 2, do
not try to rotate the PTO shaft.
7. Insert the PTO rod (10) to the hole (11) or PTO arm (9).
Then, install the PTO cover assembly (4) with PTO clutch (7) to
the transaxle case (3).
(1) Stud Bolt (8) 24T Gear
(2) Ball Bearing (9) PTO Arm
(3) Transaxle Case (10) PTO Rod
(4) PTO Cover Assembly (11) Hole
(5) Sealing Groove
(6) Brake Friction Plate 2 (A) Alignment of the tongues of
(7) PTO Clutch Assembly Brake Friction Plate 1 and 2
(To be continued)

2-S35

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM TRANSAXLE
(Continued)
1. Align the bolt holes of PTO cover assembly (13) with the stud
bolts (1). Then slide the PTO cover assembly (13) slowly in
direction of arrow in figure.
2. When the distance "A" is 15 to 16 mm (0.59 to 0.62 in.), the
PTO cover assembly (13) would be blocked from sliding.
In this case, push the PTO cover assembly (13) softly while
slightly turning the PTO shaft (12).
3. When the distance "A" is 8.0 to 9.0 mm (0.32 to 0.35 in.), the
PTO cover assembly (13) may be blocked from sliding again
because the tongues (16) of brake friction plate do not align with
the grooves (14) of transaxle case.
In this case, slightly pull out the PTO shaft (12), and turn the
brake friction plate 2 with a minus screwdriver so that the
tongues (16) of it align with the grooves (14) of transaxle case.
NOTE
• Do not touch the liquid gasket applied on the PTO cover
assembly (13).
4. When the tongues (16) of brake friction plate 2 align with the
grooves of transaxle case, further push the PTO cover
assembly (13). If the PTO cover assembly (13) is installed
correctly, the distance "A" should become 5.0 mm (0.20 in.) or
less.
5. Install the PTO cover mounting bolts in three remained bolt
holes. And tighten them slowly and evenly until the PTO cover
assembly (13) contacts to the transaxle case.
6. Remove the stud bolts (1), and replace with the PTO cover
mounting bolts. Then tighten all bolts with the specific torque.
7. Check the following movement of PTO shaft (12) while raising
the PTO arm (18).
Position of PTO Arm (18) Movement of PTO Shaft (12)
Within a play from the lowest
1 Can Not be turned by hand
position
Range where clutch spring
2 Can be turned by hand
resistance is felt
3 PTO arm is the highest position Can Not be turned by hand

18 to 20 N·m
Tightening torque PTO Cover Mounting Bolt 1.8 to 2.1 kgf·m
13 to 15 lbf·ft

(1) Stud bolt (15) Transaxle Case


(12) PTO Shaft (16) Tongue
(13) PTO Cover Assembly (17) PTO Cover Mounting Bolt
(14) Groove (18) PTO Arm
(To be continued)

2-S36

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM TRANSAXLE
(Continued)
1. Install the PTO rod spring (19). (Refer to 2-S14.)
2. Remove the filling plug with the dipstick (23), and fill the new
transmission fluid to "H" level on the dipstick.
3. Start the engine, and perform the following operations.
However, absolutely avoid engaging the PTO lever during this
operation.
a) 1) Depress the speed change pedal alternately to the
forward side and reverse side in order to move the machine
forward and backward.
b) Rotate the steering wheel to the right and left to turn the
front wheels right and left.
c) Operate the mower lift lever in order to make the mower
deck go up and down.
d) During the operation described above, check to see if no oil
leakage from the transaxle assembly and each hydraulic
pipe is found.
4. At least 5 minutes after stopping the engine, check the oil level
again, using the dipstick.
5. If the oil level is lower than the "H" level indicated on the
dipstick, fill the oil tank with transmission fluid additionally up to
the "H" level.
6. Perform the above-mentioned operation again. And make sure
that the oil level is not low level.
7. Disconnect the universal joint of mower deck form the PTO
shaft. Shaft the PTO lever to "Engage" position, and check to
see if the PTO shaft rotates quickly without abnormal noise.
Next, shift the PTO lever to the "Disengage" position, and
check to see if the PTO shaft stops operation quickly without
abnormal noise.
IMPORTANT
• Park the machine on level ground.
• Use the KUBOTA UDT or SUPER UDT fluid. Use of other
oils may damage the transmission or hydraulic system.
Refer to "4. LUBRICANTS, FUEL AND COOLANT" on page
G-9.
• Do not mix different brand oil together.
2.8 L
Transmission fluid Capacity 0.74 U.S.gals
0.62 lmp.gals

(19) PTO Rod Spring (22) PTO Rod


(20) Nut (23) Filling Plug With Dipstick
(21) Nut
9Y1210595TXS0089US0

2-S37

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM TRANSAXLE

[4] SERVICING
(1) Hydrostatic Transmission
Charge Pump
1. Check the charge pump housing (1) and gerotor assembly (2)
for scratches and wear.
2. If scratch or worn, replace the charge pump assembly.
(1) Charge Pump Housing (2) Gerotor Assembly
9Y1210595TXS0058US0

Center Section
1. Check the surfaces (1) of center section for scratches or wear.
2. If deep scratch or excessive wear is found, replace the
hydrostatic transmission assembly.
(1) Surface
9Y1210595TXS0059US0

Check Valve
1. Check the ball check (5) and check valve (4) for scratches and
damage.
2. Check the springs (3), (6) for breakage and wear.
3. If anything unusual, replace the check valve assembly.
(1) Plug (5) Ball Check
(2) O-ring (6) Spring
(3) Spring (7) O-ring
(4) Check Valve (8) Plug
9Y1210595TXS0060US0

By-pass Valve
1. Check the by-pass spool (3) and spring (4).
2. If problems are found, replace them.
(1) Plug (3) By-pass Spool
(2) O-ring (4) Spring
9Y1210595TXS0091US0

2-S38

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM TRANSAXLE
Cylinder Block Assembly
1. Check the cylinder blocks (4) and pistons (3) for scratches and
wear.
2. If you find, replace the cylinder block assembly.
3. Check that the piston (3) and spring (2) are in each cylinder
bore.
4. Check the pistons for their free movement in the cylinder block
bores.
5. If the piston or the cylinder block is scored, replace the cylinder
block assembly.
6. Check the polished face (1) of cylinder block for scoring.
7. If scored, replace the cylinder block assembly.
IMPORTANT
• Do not interchange pistons between pump and motor
cylinder block. Pistons and cylinder blocks are matched.
(1) Polished Face (3) Piston
(2) Spring (4) Cylinder Block
9Y1210595TXS0062US0
Thrust Ball Bearing
1. Check the thrust ball bearing (1) for scratches and excessive
wear.
2. If the thrust ball bearing (1) is worn, replace it.
(1) Thrust Ball Bearing
9Y1210595TXS0063US0

Pump Shaft
1. Check the seal surface (1), the bearing surface (2) and the ball
bearing (3).
2. If the shaft is rough or grooved, replace it.
3. If the ball bearing is worn, replace it.
(1) Seal Surface (3) Ball Bearing
(2) Bearing Surface
9Y1210595TXS0064US0

Bushing and Oil Seal


1. Check the oil seals (1) for damage.
2. Check the bushings (2) for wear.
3. If the oil seals and bushings are worn or damaged, replace
them.
(1) Oil Seal (2) Bushing
9Y1210595TXS0065US0

2-S39

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM TRANSAXLE

(2) Transaxle Case


Checking Bearing
1. Hold the inner race, and push and pull the outer race in all
directions to check for wear and roughness.
2. Apply transmission fluid to the bearing, and hold the inner race.
Then, turn the outer race to check rotation.
3. If there is any problem replace it.
9Y1210595TXS0090US0

PTO Clutch Disc Wear


1. Measure the thickness of PTO clutch disc with vernier calipers.
2. If the thickness is less than the allowable limit, replace it.
1.3 to 1.5 mm
Factory specification
Thickness of PTO clutch 0.052 to 0.059 in.
disc 1.2 mm
Allowable limit
0.047 in.
9Y1210595TXS0067US0

Pressure Plate and Friction Plate Wear


1. Measure the thickness of pressure plate and friction plate 1, 2
with vernier calipers.
2. If the thickness is less than the allowable limit, replace it.
1.55 to 1.65 mm
Factory specification
Thickness of pressure 0.0611 to 0.0649 in.
plate 1.50 mm
Allowable limit
0.0591 in.

1.55 to 1.65 mm
Factory specification
Thickness of pressure 0.0611 to 0.0649 in.
plate 1 1.50 mm
Allowable limit
0.0591 in.

0.75 to 0.85 mm
Factory specification
Thickness of pressure 0.030 to 0.033 in.
plate 2 0.70 mm
Allowable limit
0.028 in.
9Y1210595TXS0068US0

Clutch Spring Free Length


1. Measure the free length of spring with vernier calipers.
2. If the measurement is less than the allowable limit, replace it.
45 mm
Factory specification
1.8 in.
Clutch spring free length
42 mm
Allowable limit
1.7 in.
9Y1210595TXS0069US0

2-S40

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM TRANSAXLE
PTO Brake Disc Wear
1. Measure the thickness of PTO brake disc with a vernier caliper.
2. If the thickness is less than the allowable limit, replace it.
3.30 to 3.50 mm
Factory specification
PTO brake disc 0.130 to 0.137 in.
thickness 3.00 mm
Allowable limit
0.118 in.
9Y1210595TXS0070US0

Friction Plate Wear


1. Measure the thickness of brake friction plate 1, 2 with vernier
calipers.
2. If the thickness is less than the allowable limit, replace it.
1.75 to 1.85 mm
Factory specification
Thickness of brake 0.0689 to 0.0728 in.
friction plate 1 1.60 mm
Allowable limit
0.0630 in.

0.950 to 1.05 mm
Factory specification
Thickness of brake 0.0374 to 0.0413 in.
friction plate 2 0.80 mm
Allowable limit
0.031 in.
9Y1210595TXS0071US0
Clearance between Differential Gear Case and Differential Side
Gear
1. Measure the differential gear case (4) bore I.D..
2. Measure the differential side gear (3) boss O.D., and calculate
the clearance.
3. Measure the 42T gear (1) bore I.D..
4. Measure the differential side gear (2) boss O.D., and calculate
the clearance.
5. If the clearance exceeds the allowable limit, replace faulty parts.
0.040 to 0.082 mm
Clearance between Factory specification
0.0016 to 0.0032 in.
differential case and
differential side gear 0.17 mm
Allowable limit
0.0067 in.
0.040 to 0.082 mm
Clearance between 42T Factory specification
0.0016 to 0.0032 in.
gear and differential side
gear 0.17 mm
Allowable limit
0.0067 in.

Differential case bore 22.500 to 22.521 mm


Factory specification
I.D. 0.88583 to 0.88665 in.
Differential side gear 22.439 to 22.460 mm
Factory specification
boss O.D. 0.88343 to 0.88425 in.
22.500 to 22.521 mm
42T gear bore I.D. Factory specification
0.88583 to 0.88665 in.

(1) 42T Gear (3) Differential Side Gear


(2) Differential Side Gear (4) Differential Gear Case
9Y1210595TXS0072US0

2-S41

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM TRANSAXLE
Clearance between Differential Pinion Gear and Differential
Pinion Shaft
1. Measure the differential pinion gear (1) I.D..
2. Measure the differential pinion shaft (2) O.D., and calculate the
clearance.
3. If the clearance exceeds the allowable limit, replace faulty parts.
Clearance between 0.025 to 0.055 mm
Factory specification
differential pinion gear 0.00099 to 0.0021 in.
and differential pinion 0.25 mm
shaft Allowable limit
0.0098 in.

Differential pinion gear 10.000 to 10.015 mm


Factory specification
I.D. 0.39370 to 0.39429 in.
Differential pinion shaft 9.960 to 9.975 mm
Factory specification
O.D. 0.3922 to 0.3927 in.

(1) Differential Pinion Gear (2) Differential Pinion Shaft


9Y1210595TXS0073US0
Backlash between Differential Pinion Gear and Differential
Side Gear
1. Stick a strip of plastigauge the three spots on the differential
pinion gear (2) with grease.
2. Reassemble the differential gear assembly.
3. Fix the differential gear assembly, and install the drive shaft (5).
4. Turn the drive shaft (5).
5. Remove the differential pinion gear (2) from the differential gear
assembly, and measure the thickness of the plastigauge with an
outside micrometer.
6. If the backlash is not within the factory specifications, adjust with
shims (4), (6).
Backlash between
0.15 to 0.30 mm
differential pinion gear Factory specification
0.0059 to 0.011 in.
and differential side gear

(Reference)
• Thickness of adjusting shims
For differential pinion gear:
2.3 mm (0.091 in.)
2.5 mm (0.098 in.)
2.7 mm (0.11 in.)
2.9 mm (0.11 in.)
• Tooth contact: More than 35 %
(1) Differential Side Gear (4) Shim
(2) Differential Pinion Gear (5) Drive Shaft
(3) Differential Pinion Shaft (6) Shim
9Y1210595TXS0074US0

2-S42

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM TRANSAXLE
Backlash between 11T Bevel Gear Shaft and 17T-13T Gear
Shaft
1. Stick a strip of plastigauge the three spots on the 11T bevel gear
shaft (3) with grease.
2. Reassemble the hydrostatic transmission and transaxle case.
3. Fix the transaxle case, and push the by-pass valve.
4. Turn the motor shaft.
5. Remove the 11T bevel gear shaft (3), and measure the
thickness of the plastigauges with an outside micrometer.
Backlash between 11T
0.15 to 0.30 mm
bevel gear shaft and Factory specification
0.0059 to 0.011 in.
17T-13T gear shaft

(Reference)
• Thickness of adjusting shims
For 11T bevel gear shaft (3):
0.2 mm (0.008 in.)
0.3 mm (0.012 in.)
0.5 mm (0.020 in.)
For 17T-13T gear shaft (LH) (1):
0.2 mm (0.008 in.)
0.3 mm (0.012 in.)
0.5 mm (0.020 in.)
For 17T-13T gear shaft (RH) (5):
0.2 mm (0.008 in.)
0.3 mm (0.012 in.)
0.5 mm (0.020 in.)
• Tooth contact: More than 35 %
(1) Shim (for 17T-13T Gear Shaft (LH)) (4) Shim (for 11T Bevel Gear Shaft)
(2) 17T-13T Gear Shaft (5) Shim (for 17T-13T Gear Shaft (RH))
(3) 11T Gear Shaft
9Y1210595TXS0075US0

2-S43

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


3 BRAKES

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


MECHANISM

CONTENTS

1. BRAKE MECHANISM................................................................................................................. 3-M1

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM BRAKES

1. BRAKE MECHANISM
Internal expanding brake drum is used in braking
system for GR series.
Brake drum (1) is connected to idle gear shaft.
Idle gear shaft is located between drive gear and
final gear.
Brake shoes (4) will be expanded via brake cam
lever (2) when you press the brake pedal.
Brake shoes (4) expand outward and it is touched
inside of brake drum (1). Friction between brake shoes
(4) and drum generates braking power.
(1) Brake Drum A: Disengage
(2) Brake Cam Lever B: Engage
(3) Brake Assy
(4) Brake Shoe
(5) Cam Pin
(6) Brake Fulcrum
(7) Spring
9Y1210595BRM0001US0

3-M1

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


SERVICING

CONTENTS

1. TROUBLESHOOTING.................................................................................................................3-S1
2. SERVICING SPECIFICATIONS ..................................................................................................3-S2
3. TIGHTENING TORQUES............................................................................................................3-S3
4. CHECKING, DISASSEMBLING AND SERVICING .....................................................................3-S4
[1] CHECKING AND ADJUSTING..............................................................................................3-S4
[2] DISASSEMBLING AND ASSEMBLING ................................................................................3-S4
(1) Pedal System Component...............................................................................................3-S4
(2) Brake Assembly...............................................................................................................3-S7

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM BRAKES

1. TROUBLESHOOTING
Reference
Symptom Probable Cause Solution
Page
Insufficient Braking Brake pedal free travel excessive Adjust 3-S4
Force Brake shoe worn Replace 3-S7
Brake drum worn Replace 3-S7
Grease or oil on brake shoe Replace 3-S7
Brake Drags Brake pedal free travel too small Adjust 3-S4
Brake spring weaken or broken Replace 3-S7
Heavy Brakes Brake pedal rusted Repair or replace 3-S6
Brake cam lever rusted Replace 3-S7
9Y1210595BRS0001US0

3-S1

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM BRAKES

2. SERVICING SPECIFICATIONS
Item Factory Specification Allowable Limit
Brake Pedal Free Travel 15 to 25 mm –
0.59 to 0.98 in.
9Y1210595BRS0002US0

3-S2

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM BRAKES

3. TIGHTENING TORQUES
Tightening torques of screws, bolts and nuts on the table below are especially specified.
(For general use screws, bolts and nuts: Refer to "5. TIGHTENING TORQUES" on page G-12.)
Item N·m kgf·m lbf·ft
Steering wheel mounting nut 20 to 24 2.0 to 2.5 15 to 18
Drag link locking nut 76 to 80 7.7 to 8.2 56 to 59
Steering support mounting screw 48 to 55 4.9 to 5.7 36 to 41
Pedal system component mounting nut 48 to 55 4.9 to 5.7 36 to 41
9Y1210595BRS0003US0

3-S3

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM BRAKES

4. CHECKING, DISASSEMBLING AND SERVICING


[1] CHECKING AND ADJUSTING
Brake Pedal Free Travel

CAUTION
• Stop the engine, remove the key, and chock the wheels
before checking brake pedal.
1. Release the parking brake.
2. Loosen the lock nut (1) and adjusting nut (2).
3. Lift up the break arm (4) by the hard.
4. Tighten the adjusting nut (2) so that the top of the brake spring
(3) touches to the brake arm (4). Next loosen the adjusting nut
(2) by 3 turns.
5. Retighten the lock nut (1).
6. Make sure that the brake pedal free travel is form 15 to 25 mm.
Then, with the brake pedal completely released, push the
bypass valve of HST and ensure that the rear wheel rotates.
Brake pedal free travel 15 to 25 mm
Factory specification
"B" 0.59 to 0.98 in.

(Reference)
• Brake spring length "A": 73.0 to 74.0 mm (2.88 to 2.91 in.)
(1) Lock Nut (3) Brake Spring
(2) Adjusting Nut (4) Brake Arm
9Y1210595BRS0016US0

[2] DISASSEMBLING AND ASSEMBLING


(1) Pedal System Component
Dismounting Mower
1. Refer to "[2] PREPARATION (DISMOUNTING MOWER)" on
page 7-S10.
9Y1210595TXS0017US0
Removing Container
1. Refer to "[2] PREPARATION" on page 2-S10.
9Y1210595BRS0005US0
Battery
1. Refer to 2-S13.
9Y1210595BRS0006US0
Discharge Duct
1. Refer to 2-S11.
9Y1210595BRS0007US0
Container Base
1. Refer to 2-S11.
9Y1210595BRS0008US0
Seat
1. Remove two snap pins (2), (4).
2. Remove the seat (1) and snap plate (3).
(1) Seat (3) Snap Plate
(2) Snap Pin (4) Snap Pin
9Y1210595TXS0019US0

3-S4

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM BRAKES
Fender
1. Remove the speed change pedal (5).
2. Peel the step sheet (4) halfway.
3. Remove the fuel cap (1).
4. Remove the fender (2).
(1) Fuel Cap (4) Step Sheet
(2) Fender (5) Speed Change Pedal
(3) Fender Mounting Screw
9Y1210595BRS0009US0

Steering Wheel, Side Bonnet and Panel


1. Remove the steering wheel (1).
2. Remove the side bonnet (3).
3. Remove the accelerator lever grip.
4. Disconnect the connectors for hour meter (4), main switch (5)
and light switch.
5. Remove the indicator lamps (6).
6. Remove the fuse box (7) from the steering support.
7. Remove the panel (2).
(When reassembling)
20 to 24 N·m
Steering Wheel mounting
Tightening torque 2.0 to 2.5 kgf·m
nut
15 to 18 lbf·ft

(1) Steering Wheel (5) Main Switch


(2) Panel (6) Indicator Lamp
(3) Side Bonnet (7) Fuse Box
(4) Hour Meter
9Y1210595BRS0010US0

Separating Engine
1. Refer to "[2] PREPARATION" on page 1-S19.
9Y1210595BRS0011US0

3-S5

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM BRAKES
Steering Support Assembly
1. Disconnect the drag link (4) from the sector gear (3).
2. Disconnect the connectors for the starter relay, timer relay,
regulator and buzzer unit.
3. Disconnect the accelerator wire (2).
4. Separate the steering support assembly (1).
(When reassembling)
76 to 80 N·m
Drag link locking nut 7.7 to 8.2 kgf·m
56 to 59 lbf·ft
Tightening torque
48 to 55 N·m
Steering support mounting
4.9 to 5.7 kgf·m
screw
36 to 41 lbf·ft

(1) Steering Support (3) Sector Gear


(2) Accelerator Wire (4) Drag Link
9Y1210595BRS0012US0
Brake Rod and Speed Change Rod
1. Disconnect the brake rod 1 (1) from the pedal system
component.
2. Disconnect the speed change rod (2) from the pedal system
component.
(1) Brake Rod 1 (2) Speed Change Rod
9Y1210595BRS0013US0

Pedal System Component


1. Remove the parking lock spring (1).
2. Remove the pedal system component mounting nuts (2).
3. Separate the pedal system component (3) from frame.
(When reassembling)
48 to 55 N·m
Pedal system component
Tightening torque 4.9 to 5.7 kgf·m
mounting nut
36 to 41 lbf·ft

(1) Parking Lock Spring (3) Pedal System Component


(2) Pedal System Component Mounting
Nut
9Y1210595BRS0014US0

3-S6

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM BRAKES

(2) Brake Assembly


Brake Assembly
1. Remove the lock nut (1), plain washers (2) and brake spring (3).
2. Remove the brake plate (5).
3. Remove the brake rod (4).
4. Remove the brake assembly (6).
5. Remove the external snap ring (8).
6. Pull out the brake drum (9).
(When reassembling)
• Apply liquid gasket (Three Bond 1206D or equivalent) to joint
face of the brake assembly.
• Tighten the brake assembly mounting screws (7) while pushing
up the brake arm lever (10) by the hand.
NOTE
• After assembling the brake assembly, be sure to adjust the
brake pedal free travel. (Refer to "[1] CHECKING AND
ADJUSTING" on page 3-S4.)
7.9 to 8.8 N·m
Brake Assembly Mounting
Tightening torque 0.80 to 0.80 kgf·m
Screw
5.8 to 6.5 lbf·ft

(1) Lock Nut (6) Brake Assembly


(2) Plain Washer (7) Brake Assembly Mounting Screw
(3) Brake Spring (8) External Snap Ring
(4) Brake Rod (9) Brake Drum
(5) Brake Plate (10) Brake Arm Lever
9Y1210595BRS0015US0

3-S7

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


4 FRONT AXLE

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


SERVICING

CONTENTS

1. TROUBLESHOOTING.................................................................................................................4-S1
2. SERVICING SPECIFICATIONS ..................................................................................................4-S2
3. TIGHTENING TORQUES............................................................................................................4-S3
4. CHECKING, DISASSEMBLING AND SERVICING .....................................................................4-S4
[1] CHECKING AND ADJUSTING..............................................................................................4-S4
[2] PREPARATION .....................................................................................................................4-S4
(1) Separating Front Axle Assembly .....................................................................................4-S4
[3] DISASSEMBLING AND ASSEMBLING ................................................................................4-S6
(1) Front Axle Assembly........................................................................................................4-S6
[4] SERVICING ...........................................................................................................................4-S6

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM FRONT AXLE

1. TROUBLESHOOTING
Reference
Symptom Probable Cause Solution
Page
Front Wheels Wander Tire pressure uneven Adjust G-60
to Right or Left Improper toe-in Replace tie-rod 4-S4,
4-S6
Kingpin worn Replace front axle 4-S5
assembly
Center pin collar worn Replace 4-S5,
4-S6
Center pin locking nut loosen Tighten 4-S5
Front Wheels Improper toe-in Replace tie-rod 4-S4,
Shimmy 4-S6
Kingpin worn Replace front axle 4-S5
assembly
Center pin collar worn Replace 4-S5,
4-S6
Steering linkage loosen or worn Tighten or replace 4-S5
9Y1210595FBS0001US0

4-S1

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM FRONT AXLE

2. SERVICING SPECIFICATIONS
Item Factory Specification Allowable Limit
Front Wheel Alignment Toe-in 1.0 to 10 mm –
0.040 to 0.39 in.
Front Axle Frame to Anti-vibration Bolt Clearance 0.30 to 0.50 mm –
0.012 to 0.019 in.
Center Pin to Center Pin Collar Clearance 0.109 to 0.200 mm 0.210 mm
0.00430 to 0.00787 in. 0.00827 in.

Center Pin Boss 25.400 to 25.430 mm –


(I.D.) 1.0000 to 1.0011 in.

Center Pin Collar 25.230 to 25.291 mm –


(O.D.) 0.99331 to 0.99570 in.
9Y1210595FBS0002US0

4-S2

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM FRONT AXLE

3. TIGHTENING TORQUES
Tightening torques of screws, bolts and nuts on the table below are especially specified.
(For general use screws, bolts and nuts: Refer to "5. TIGHTENING TORQUES" on page G-12.)
Item N·m kgf·m lbf·ft
Center pin locking nut 78 to 90 7.9 to 9.2 58 to 66
Tie-rod mounting locking nut 48 to 55 4.9 to 5.7 36 to 41
9Y1210595FBS0003US0

4-S3

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM FRONT AXLE

4. CHECKING, DISASSEMBLING AND SERVICING


[1] CHECKING AND ADJUSTING
Toe-in
1. Inflate the tires to the specified pressure.
2. Turn the front wheels straight ahead.
3. Measure the toe-in (B-A).
4. If the measurement is not within the factory specifications,
replace the tie-rod.
1.0 to 10 mm
Toe-in (B-A) Factory specification
0.040 to 0.39 in.

(A) Wheel to Wheel Distance at Front (C) Front


(B) Wheel to Wheel Distance at Rear
9Y1210595FBS0004US0
Anti-Vibration Bolt
1. Jack up the front of machine.
2. Measure the clearance between the front axle frame (1) and
anti-vibration bolt (2).
3. If the measurement exceeds the factory specification, adjust the
anti-vibration bolt.
Clearance between front
0.30 to 0.50 mm
axle frame and Factory specification
0.012 to 0.019 in.
anti-vibration bolt

(1) Front Axle Frame A: Clearance


(2) Anti-Vibration Bolt
9Y1210595FBS0005US0

[2] PREPARATION
(1) Separating Front Axle Assembly
Dismounting Mower
1. Refer to "[2] PREPARATION (DISMOUNTING MOWER)" on
page 7-S10.
9Y1210595TXS0017US0
Battery

CAUTION
• When disconnecting the battery cables, disconnect the
negative cable from the battery first. When connecting,
connect the positive cable to the battery first.
1. Open the bonnet.
2. Disconnect the negative cable (1) from the battery.
3. Disconnect the positive cable (2) from the battery and remove
the battery (3).
(1) Negative Cable (3) Battery
(2) Positive Cable
9Y1210595ENS0023US0

4-S4

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM FRONT AXLE
Bonnet and Side Bonnet
1. Disconnect the connectors (5) from the head light.
2. Remove the wire harness (4) from the bonnet.
3. Remove the bonnet (1) with bonnet bracket (2).
4. Remove the side bonnet (3).
(1) Bonnet (4) Wire Harness
(2) Bonnet Bracket (5) Connector
(3) Side Bonnet
9Y1210595ENS0024US0

Separating Front Axle Assembly


1. Disconnect the drag link (1) from the front axle assembly (2).
2. Support the front of frame with jacks.
3. Remove the front wheels.
4. Loose the anti-vibration bolts (5).
5. Remove the center pin locking nut (3), and draw out the center
pin bolt (6).
6. Separate the front axle assembly (2).
(When reassembling)
• Apply grease to the outer side of center pin collar (4).
78 to 90 N·m
Tightening torque Center pin locking nut 7.9 to 9.2 kgf·m
58 to 66 lbf·ft

(1) Drag Link (4) Center Pin Collar


(2) Front Axle Assembly (5) Anti-vibration Bolt
(3) Center Pin Locking Nut (6) Center Pin Bolt
9Y1210595FBS0006US0

4-S5

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM FRONT AXLE

[3] DISASSEMBLING AND ASSEMBLING


(1) Front Axle Assembly
Tie-rod
1. Remove the tie-rod mounting locking nut (1).
2. Remove the tie-rod (2).
48 to 55 N·m
Tie-rod mounting locking
Tightening torque 4.9 to 5.7 kgf·m
nut
36 to 41 lbf·ft

(1) Tie-rod Mounting Locking Nut (2) Tie-rod


9Y1210595FBS0007US0

[4] SERVICING
Clearance between Center Pin Boss and Center Pin Collar
1. Measure the center pin boss (2) I.D. with a cylinder gauge.
2. Measure the center pin collar (3) O.D. with an outside
micrometer and calculate the clearance.
3. If the clearance exceeds the allowable limit, replace them.
0.109 to 0.200 mm
Clearance between Factory specification
0.00430 to 0.00787 in.
center pin boss and
center pin collar 0.210 mm
Allowable limit
0.0827 in.

25.400 to 25.430 mm
Center pin boss I.D. "A" Factory specification
1.0000 to 1.00117 in.
Center pin collar O.D. 25.230 to 25.291 mm
Allowable limit
"B" 0.99331 to 0.99570 in.

(1) Front Axle Frame (3) Center Pin Collar


(2) Center Pin Boss
9Y1210595FBS0008US0

4-S6

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


5 STEERING

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


SERVICING

CONTENTS

1. TROUBLESHOOTING.................................................................................................................5-S1
2. SERVICING SPECIFICATIONS ..................................................................................................5-S2
3. TIGHTENING TORQUES............................................................................................................5-S3
4. CHECKING, DISASSEMNLING AND SERVICING.....................................................................5-S4
[1] CHECKING AND ADJUSTING..............................................................................................5-S4
[2] PREPARATION .....................................................................................................................5-S4
(1) Separating Steering Support Assembly...........................................................................5-S4
[3] DISASSEMBLING AND ASSEMBLING ................................................................................5-S6
(1) Steering Support Assembly .............................................................................................5-S6
[4] SERVICING ...........................................................................................................................5-S6

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM STEERING

1. TROUBLESHOOTING
Reference
Symptom Probable Cause Solution
Page
Inoperable Steering Steering shaft and sector gear broken Replace 5-S6
Steering linkage broken Replace 5-S5
Hard Steering Tire pressure uneven Adjust G-60
Improper alignment of front wheels Replace tie-rod 4-S4,
4-S6
Bearing stuck Replace 5-S6
Steering shaft and sector gear stuck Replace 5-S6
9Y1210595STS0001US0

5-S1

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM STEERING

2. SERVICING SPECIFICATIONS
Item Factory Specification Allowable Limit
Steering Wheel Play 30 to 70 mm –
1.2 to 2.7 in.
9Y1210595STS0002US0

5-S2

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM STEERING

3. TIGHTENING TORQUES
Tightening torques of screws, bolts and nuts on the table below are especially specified.
(For general use screws, bolts and nuts: Refer to "5. TIGHTENING TORQUES" on page G-12.)
Item N·m kgf·m lbf·ft
Steering wheel mounting nut 20 to 24 2.0 to 2.5 15 to 18
Drag link locking nut 75 to 81 7.6 to 8.3 55 to 60
Steering support mounting screw 48 to 55 4.9 to 5.7 36 to 41
Sector gear mounting screw 48 to 55 4.9 to 5.7 36 to 41
9Y1210595STS0003US0

5-S3

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM STEERING

4. CHECKING, DISASSEMNLING AND SERVICING


[1] CHECKING AND ADJUSTING
Steering Wheel Play
1. Turn the front wheels straight ahead.
2. Rotate the steering wheel lightly by hand, and measure the play.
3. If the measurement exceeds the factory specifications, replace
the steering shaft and sector gear.
30 to 70 mm
Steering wheel play Factory specification
1.2 to 2.7 in.
9Y1210595STS0004US0

[2] PREPARATION
(1) Separating Steering Support Assembly
Dismounting Mower
1. Refer to "[2] PREPARATION (DISMOUNTING MOWER)" on
page 7-S10.
9Y1210595TXS0017US0
Removing Container
1. Refer to "[2] PREPARATION" on page 2-S10.
9Y1210595BRS0005US0
Battery
1. Refer to 2-S13.
9Y1210595BRS0006US0
Discharge Duct
1. Refer to 2-S11.
9Y1210595BRS0007US0
Container Base
1. Refer to 2-S11.
9Y1210595BRS0008US0
Seat
1. Remove two snap pins (2), (4).
2. Remove the seat (1) and snap plate (3).
(1) Seat (3) Snap Plate
(2) Snap Pin (4) Snap Pin
9Y1210595TXS0019US0

Fender
1. Remove the speed change pedal (5).
2. Peel the step sheet (4) halfway.
3. Remove the fuel cap (1).
4. Remove the fender (2).
(1) Fuel Cap (4) Step Sheet
(2) Fender (5) Speed Change Pedal
(3) Fender Mounting Screw
9Y1210595BRS0009US0

5-S4

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM STEERING
Steering Wheel, Side Bonnet and Panel
1. Remove the steering wheel (1).
2. Remove the side bonnet (3).
3. Remove the accelerator lever grip.
4. Disconnect the connectors for hour meter (4), main switch (5)
and light switch.
5. Remove the indicator lamps (6).
6. Remove the fuse box (7) from the steering support.
7. Remove the panel (2).
(When reassembling)
20 to 24 N·m
Steering Wheel mounting
Tightening torque 2.0 to 2.5 kgf·m
nut
15 to 18 lbf·ft

(1) Steering Wheel (5) Main Switch


(2) Panel (6) Indicator Lamp
(3) Side Bonnet (7) Fuse Box
(4) Hour Meter
9Y1210595BRS0010US0

Separating Engine
1. Refer to "[2] PREPARATION" on page 1-S19.
9Y1210595BRS0011US0
Steering Support Assembly
1. Disconnect the drag link (4) from the sector gear (3).
2. Disconnect the connectors for the starter relay, timer relay,
regulator and buzzer unit.
3. Disconnect the accelerator wire (2).
4. Separate the steering support assembly (1).
(When reassembling)
76 to 80 N·m
Drag link locking nut 7.7 to 8.2 kgf·m
56 to 59 lbf·ft
Tightening torque
48 to 55 N·m
Steering support mounting
4.9 to 5.7 kgf·m
screw
36 to 41 lbf·ft

(1) Steering Support (3) Sector Gear


(2) Accelerator Wire (4) Drag Link
9Y1210595BRS0012US0

5-S5

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM STEERING

[3] DISASSEMBLING AND ASSEMBLING


(1) Steering Support Assembly
Steering Shaft and Sector Gear
1. Remove the shaft retainer (4).
2. Remove the sector gear mounting screw (5), and remove the
sector gear (8).
3. Remove the steering bearing (1) and ball bearing (3).
4. Pull out the steering shaft (2).
(When reassembling)
• Apply to grease to the sector gear teeth.
• Apply to grease to the pinion teeth of steering shaft.
• Apply to grease to the sector bushes (6), (7).
• Apply to grease to the steering bearing.
• Adjust the clearance between the shaft retainer and the pinion
gear of steering shaft.
(Reference)
• Length "L": 1 mm (0.04 in.)
48 to 55 N·m
Steering wheel mounting
Tightening torque 4.9 to 5.7 kgf·m
nut
36 to 41 lbf·ft

(1) Steering Bearing (5) Sector Gear Mounting Screw


(2) Steering Shaft (6) Sector Bush
(3) Ball Bearing (7) Sector Bush
(4) Shaft Retainer (8) Sector Gear
9Y1210595STS0005US0

[4] SERVICING
Steering Support Bushing Wear
1. Visually inspect the sector bushes (1) for signs of wear or
damage.
2. If problem are found, replace the sector bush (1).
(1) Sector Bush
9Y1210595STS0007US0

5-S6

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


6 ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


MECHANISM

CONTENTS

1. WIRING DIAGRAM..................................................................................................................... 6-M1


[1] GR1600EU, GR1600F.......................................................................................................... 6-M1
[2] GR1600ID............................................................................................................................. 6-M2
2. STARTING SYSTEM.................................................................................................................. 6-M3
[1] GR1600EU, GR1600F.......................................................................................................... 6-M3
[2] GR1600ID............................................................................................................................. 6-M4
3. CHARGING SYSTEM................................................................................................................. 6-M5
4. LIGHTING SYSTEM AND METER PANEL ................................................................................ 6-M6
[1] GR1600EU, GR1600F.......................................................................................................... 6-M6
[2] GR1600ID............................................................................................................................. 6-M7

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

1. WIRING DIAGRAM
[1] GR1600EU, GR1600F

6-M1

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

[2] GR1600ID

6-M2

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

2. STARTING SYSTEM
[1] GR1600EU, GR1600F

(1) Battery (7) Slow Blow Fuse (40 A) (13) Grass Container Open Switch (18) Fuse (IG/M) (10 A)
(2) GND (8) Fuel Feed Pump (14) Grass Container Open Relay (19) Main Switch
(3) Starter Motor (9) Fuse (Engine Stop) (15 A) (15) Top Cover Open Switch (20) Brake Switch
(4) Glow Plug (10) Starter Relay (16) Diode (3A) (21) PTO Switch
(5) Engine Stop Solenoid (11) Engine Stop Time Relay (17) Fuse (OPC) (3 A) (22) Glow Plug Lamp
(6) GND (12) Seat Switch

When the main switch (19) is turned to the PREHEAT position, the terminal BAT is connected to the terminals
GLOW and ON. The glow plugs (4) become red-hot, and the glow plug (preheat indicator) lamp also lights on while
preheating.
When the main switch (19) is then turned to the START position with the brake switch (20) on and PTO switch
(21) on, the terminal BAT is connected to the terminals START and ON. Consequently, battery current flows to the
starter motor (3) and start the engine.
The main switch (19) automatically returns to the ON position, the terminal BAT is connected only to the terminal
ON, thereby causing the starting circuit to be opened, stopping the starter motor (3).
When the main switch (19) turned from the ON position to the OFF position, the engine stop solenoid (5) moves
the fuel injection pump control rack to the "No Fuel Injection" position and stop the engine.
This machine equipped the operator presence control (OPC) system which automatically stops the engine when
operator stands from the seat while shifting the PTO lever.
With the PTO lever shifted to the "ENGAGE" position, the engine of this machine stops automatically when the
cover of the grass container opens, the grass container opens or dismounted.
9Y1210595ELM0001US0

6-M3

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

[2] GR1600ID

(1) Battery (6) GND (11) Engine Stop Timer Relay (16) Main Switch
(2) GND (7) Slow Blow Fuse (40 A) (12) Seat Switch (17) Brake Switch
(3) Starter Motor (8) Fuel Feed Pump (13) Diode (3A) (18) PTO Switch
(4) Glow Plug (9) Fuse (Engine Stop) (15 A) (14) Fuse (OPC) (3 A) (19) Glow Plug Lamp
(5) Engine Stop Solenoid (10) Starter Relay (15) Fuse (IG/M) (10 A)

When the main switch (16) is turned to the PREHEAT position, the terminal BAT is connected to the terminals
GLOW and ON. The glow plugs (4) become red-hot, and the glow plug (preheat indicator) lamp (19) also lights on
while preheating.
When the main switch (16) is then turned to the START position with the brake switch (17) on and PTO switch
(18) on, the terminal BAT is connected to the terminals START and ON. Consequently, battery current flows to the
starter motor (3) and start the engine.
The main switch (16) automatically returns to the ON position, the terminal BAT is connected only to the terminal
ON, thereby causing the starting circuit to be opened, stopping the starter motor (3).
When the main switch (16) turned from the ON position to the OFF position, the engine stop solenoid (5) moves
the fuel injection pump control rack to the "No Fuel Injection" position and stop the engine.
This machine is equipped with the operator presence control (OPC) system which automatically stops the engine
when operator stands from the seat while shifting the PTO lever.
9Y1210595ELM0006US0

6-M4

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

3. CHARGING SYSTEM

(1) Battery (4) Dynamo (6) Regulator (8) Main Switch


(2) GND (5) Slow Blow Fuse (40 A) (7) Fuse (10 A) (9) Charge Lamp
(3) GND

The charging system supplies electric power for various electrical devices and also charges the battery while the
engine runs.
It consists of a dynamo (4) and a regulator (6).
9Y1210595ELM0002US0

6-M5

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

4. LIGHTING SYSTEM AND METER PANEL


[1] GR1600EU, GR1600F

(1) Battery (9) Regulator (16) Grass Container Full Switch (22) Oil Pressure Lamp
(2) GND (10) Fuse (10 A) Relay (23) Charge Lamp
(3) Glow Plug (11) Main Switch (17) Buzzer Relay (24) Hour Meter
(4) Coolant Temperature Switch (12) Engine Overheat Horn Relay (18) Buzzer (25) Head Light Switch
(5) Oil Pressure Switch (13) Engine Overheat Horn (19) Glow Plug Lamp (26) Head Light
(6) GND (14) Grass Container Full Switch (20) Coolant Temperature Lamp (27) Hour Meter
(7) Dynamo (15) Delay Timer (21) Grass Container Full Lamp
(8) Slow Blow Fuse (40 A)

The lighting system consists of the main switch (11), head light switch (25), head lights (26) etc..
The grass container full lamp (21) in the easy checker™ lights and the buzzer operates when the grass container
is full while shifting the PTO lever.
9Y1210595ELM0003US0

6-M6

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

[2] GR1600ID

(1) Battery (7) Dynamo (12) Engine Overheat Horn Relay (17) Charge Lamp
(2) GND (8) Slow Blow Fuse (40 A) (13) Engine Overheat Horn (18) Easy Checker™
(3) Glow Plug (9) Regulator (14) Glow Plug Lamp (19) Head Light Switch
(4) Coolant Temperature Switch (10) Fuse (10 A) (15) Coolant Temperature Lamp (20) Head Light
(5) Oil Pressure Switch (11) Main Switch (16) Oil Pressure Lamp (21) Hour Meter
(6) GND

The lighting system of this machine consists of the main switch (11), head light switch (19), head lights (20) etc..
The meter panel has Easy Checker™ (18) and engine overheat horn (13).
The coolant temperature lamp (15) lights and engine overheat horn (13) operates when the engine coolant
temperature is more than the working temperature of the coolant temperature switch (4).
The oil pressure lamp (16) lights when the engine oil pressure drops below the prescribed level.
The charge lamp (17) lights when the dynamo (7) is not charging the battery (1) while the engine runs.
9Y1210595ELM0007US0

6-M7

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


SERVICING

CONTENTS

1. TROUBLESHOOTING.................................................................................................................6-S1
2. SERVICING SPECIFICATIONS ..................................................................................................6-S4
3. TIGHTENING TORQUES............................................................................................................6-S5
4. CHEKING, DISASSEMBLING AND SERVICING........................................................................6-S6
[1] CHECKING AND ADJUSTING..............................................................................................6-S6
(1) Battery .............................................................................................................................6-S6
(2) Main Switch .....................................................................................................................6-S8
(3) Starter............................................................................................................................6-S10
(4) Safety Switch.................................................................................................................6-S11
(5) Operator Presence Control (OPC) Switch.....................................................................6-S12
(6) Glow Plug ......................................................................................................................6-S13
(7) Fuel Pump .....................................................................................................................6-S14
(8) Engine Stop Solenoid ....................................................................................................6-S14
(9) Engine Stop Timer Relay...............................................................................................6-S15
(10)Charging System...........................................................................................................6-S16
(11)Lighting System.............................................................................................................6-S17
(12)Coolant Temperature Switch.........................................................................................6-S18
(13)Grass Container Full Switch [GR1600EU, GR1600F]...................................................6-S19
(14)Grass Container Full Switch Timer Relay [GR1600EU, GR1600F] ..............................6-S20
(15)Relays (Starter, Engine Overheat Horn, Grass Container Open, Grass Container
Full Switch, Buzzer).......................................................................................................6-S21
[2] DISASSEMBLING AND ASSEMBLING ..............................................................................6-S22
(1) Starter............................................................................................................................6-S22
(2) Dynamo .........................................................................................................................6-S23
[3] SERVICING .........................................................................................................................6-S24
(1) Starter............................................................................................................................6-S24
(2) Dynamo .........................................................................................................................6-S26

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

1. TROUBLESHOOTING
Reference
Symptom Probable Cause Solution
Page
All Electrical Battery discharged or damaged Recharge or replace G-29,
Equipments Do Not 1-S20
Operate Battery positive cable disconnected or improperly Repair or replace 1-S20
connected
Battery negative cable disconnected or Repair or replace 1-S20
improperly connected
Slow blow fuse blown (40 A) Replace G-45
Fuse Blown Short-circuited Repair or replace G-45
Frequently
BATTERY
Reference
Symptom Probable Cause Solution
Page
Battery Discharges Battery damaged Replace 1-S20
Too Quickly Dynamo damaged Repair or replace 6-S23
Regulator damaged Replace 6-S16
Wiring harness disconnected or improperly Repair or replace –
connected (between battery positive terminal and
regulator B terminal)
Cooling fan belt slipping Adjust tension G-34

6-S1

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
STARTING SYSTEM
Reference
Symptom Probable Cause Solution
Page
Starter Motor Does Battery discharged or damaged Recharge or replace G-29,
Not Operate 1-S20
Slow blow fuse blown (40 A) Replace G-45
Wiring harness disconnected or improperly Repair or replace –
connected (between main switch ST terminal and
safety switches, between safety switches and
starter motor, between battery positive terminal
and starter motor)
Starter motor damaged Repair or replace 6-S22
Main switch damaged Replace 6-S8
Seat switch damaged Replace 6-S12
Brake switch damaged Replace 6-S11
PTO switch damaged Replace 6-S11
Top cover open switch damaged Replace 6-S12
Grass container open switch damaged Replace 6-S12
Engine Does Not Fuse blown (15 A) Replace G-45
Stop When Main Wiring harness disconnected or improperly Repair or replace –
Switch is Turned OFF connected (between main switch ACC terminal
and engine stop solenoid)
Engine stop solenoid damaged Replace 6-S14
Timer relay damaged Replace 6-S15
Engine Does Not Engine stop solenoid damaged Replace 6-S14
Start Timer relay damaged Replace 6-S15

CHARGING SYSTEM
Reference
Symptom Probable Cause Solution
Page
Charging Lamp Does Fuse blown (15 A) Replace G-45
Not Light when Main Bulb blown Replace G-45
Switch is Turned ON
Wiring harness disconnected or improperly Repair or replace –
connected (between main switch ACC terminal
and regulator connector terminal (yellow),
between regulator connector terminal (green)
and charge lamp)
Regulator damaged Replace –
Charging Lamp Does Dynamo damaged Repair or replace 6-S23
Not Go Off When Regulator damaged Replace 6-S16
Engine is Running

6-S2

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
LIGHTING SYSTEM
Reference
Symptom Probable Cause Solution
Page
Head Light Does Not Fuse blown (10 A) Replace G-45
Light Bulb blown Replace G-45
Wiring harness disconnected or improperly Repair or replace –
connected (between main switch ACC terminal
and head light switch, between head light switch
and head light)
Glow Plug Lamp Battery discharged or damaged Recharge or replace G-29,
Does Not Light When 1-S20
Main Switch Is in Slow blow fuse blown (40 A) Replace G-45
Pre-heat Position
Wiring harness disconnected or improperly Repair or replace –
connected (between main switch G terminal and
glow plug lamp, between glow plug lamp and
glow plugs)
Main switch damaged Replace 6-S8
Bulb blown Replace G-45
Oil Pressure Lamp Engine oil pressure too low Repair engine –
Lights Up When Engine oil insufficient Fill G-36
Engine Is Running
Oil pressure switch damaged Replace 6-S18
Short circuit between oil pressure switch lead Repair –
and chassis
Oil Pressure Lamp Fuse blown (10 A) Replace G-45
Does Not Light When Bulb blown Replace G-45
Main Switch Is
Turned ON and Oil pressure switch damaged Replace 6-S18
Engine Is Not Wiring harness disconnected or improperly Repair or replace –
Running connected (between main switch ACC terminal
and oil pressure lamp, between oil pressure lamp
and oil pressure switch)
Thermo Lamp Does Fuse blown (10 A) Replace G-45
Not Light When Main Bulb blown Replace G-45
Switch Is Turned ON
and Engine Is Not Thermo switch damaged Replace 6-S18
Running Wiring harness disconnected or improperly Repair or replace –
connected (between main switch ACC terminal
and thermo lamp, between thermo lamp and
thermo switch)
9Y1210595ELS0006US0

6-S3

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

2. SERVICING SPECIFICATIONS
Item Factory Specification Allowable Limit
Battery Voltage More than –
12 V

Potential Less than –


Difference 0.1 V
Glow Plug Resistance Approx. 0.9 Ω –
Head Light Switch Resistance OFF Infinity –

Resistance ON 0Ω –
Starter
• Commutator O.D. 28.0 mm 27.0 mm
1.10 in. 1.06 in.

• Commutator Difference of O.D. Less than 0.40 mm


0.05 mm 0.016 in.
0.002 in.

• Mica Undercut 0.50 to 0.80 mm 0.20 mm


0.020 to 0.031 in. 0.0079 in.

• Brush Length 16.0 mm 10.5 mm


0.630 in. 0.413 in.
9Y1210595ELS0007US0

6-S4

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

3. TIGHTENING TORQUES
Tightening torques of screws, bolts and nuts on the table below are especially specified.
(For general use screws, bolts and nuts: Refer to "5. TIGHTENING TORQUES" on page G-12.)
Item N·m kgf·m lbf·ft
Starter (C terminal nut) 5.9 to 11 0.60 to 1.2 4.4 to 8.6
Dynamo (stater nut) 40 to 44 4.0 to 4.5 29 to 32
9Y1210595ELS0008US0

6-S5

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

4. CHEKING, DISASSEMBLING AND SERVICING


[1] CHECKING AND ADJUSTING
(1) Battery
Battery Voltage
1. Stop the engine and turn the main switch off.
2. Connect the COM (-) lead of the voltmeter to the battery's
negative cable (1) and the (+) lead to the positive cable (2), and
measure the battery voltage.
3. If the battery voltage is less than the factory specification, check
the battery specific gravity and recharge the battery.
Battery Voltage Factory specification More than 12 V

(1) Negative Cable (3) Battery


(2) Positive Cable
9Y1210595ELS0009US0
Battery Terminal Connection
1. Turn the main switch on, and turn on the head light.
2. Measure the voltage with a voltmeter across the battery's
positive terminal post and the cable terminal, and the voltage
across the battery's negative terminal post and the chassis.
3. If the measurement exceeds the factory specification, clean the
battery terminal posts and cable clamps, and tighten them
firmly.
Potential difference Factory specification Less than 0.1 V
9Y1210595ELS0010US0

6-S6

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
Battery Charging

DANGER
To avoid serious injury or death:
• When the battery is being activated, hydrogen and oxygen
gases in the battery are extremely explosive. Keep open
sparks and flames away from the battery at all times,
especially when charging the battery.

WARNING
To avoid serious injury:
• When charging the battery, ensure the vent caps are
securely in place (if equipped).
• When disconnecting the cable from the battery, start with
the negative terminal first.
When connecting the cable to the battery, start with the
positive terminal first.
• Never check battery charge by placing a metal object
across the posts.
Use a voltmeter or hydrometer.
(For accessible maintainable type batteries with removable vent
caps.)
1. Make sure each electrolyte (3) level is to the bottom of vent
wells (4), if necessary add distilled water in a well-ventilated
area.
2. The water in the electrolyte (3) evaporates during recharging.
Liquid shortage damages the battery. Excessive liquid spills
over and damages the machine.
3. To slow charge the battery, connect the battery positive terminal
to the charger positive terminal and the negative to the negative,
then recharge in the standard fashion.
4. A boost charge is only for emergencies. It will partially charges
the battery at a high rate and in a short time.
When using a boost-charged battery, it is necessary to recharge
the battery as early as possible.
Failure to do this will shorten the battery's service life.
5. When the specific gravity of electrolyte (3) become between
1.27 and 1.29 charge has completed.
6. When exchanging an old battery into new one, use battery of
equal specification shown in "SPECIFICATIONS".
(1) Lowest Level (4) Vent Well
(2) Highest Level (5) Separator
(3) Electrolyte
(To be continued)

6-S7

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
(Continued)
(For non-accessible maintenance-free type batteries.)
Maintenance-free, non-accessible batteries are designed to
eliminate the need to add water. Yet the volume of electrolyte above
plates may eventually become depleted due to abnormal conditions
such as high heat or improper regulator setting. Use voltmeter to
check the state of charge. (See reference chart below to determine
if charging is necessary.)
Battery voltage Reference state of charge
12.6 100 % (Full charge)
12.4 75 %
12.2 50 %
12.0 25 %
11.8 0%

 Direction for Storage


1. When storing the machine for long periods of time, remove the
battery from machine, adjust the electrolyte (3) to the proper
level and store in a dry place out of direct sunlight.
2. The battery self-discharges while it is stored. Recharge it once
every three months in hot seasons and once every six months
in cold seasons.
(1) Lowest Level (4) Vent Well
(2) Highest Level (5) Separator
(3) Electrolyte
9Y1210595GEG0019US0

(2) Main Switch


Main Switch
1. Open the bonnet.
2. Disconnect the 4P connector and remove the main switch (1).
3. Perform the following checks.
(1) Main Switch
9Y1210595ELS0011US0

Connector Voltage
1. Measure the voltage with a voltmeter across the connector B
(red) terminal and chassis.
2. If the voltage differs from the battery voltage (11 to 14 V), the
wiring harness is faulty.
Connector B (Red) terminal
Voltage Approx. battery voltage
– Chassis

(1) Connector
9Y1210595ELS0012US0

6-S8

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
Main Switch Continuity
1) Main Switch Key at OFF Position
1. Set the main switch OFF position.
2. Measure the resistance with an ohmmeter across the B terminal
and the ACC terminal, B terminal and ST terminal, B terminal
and G terminal.
3. If infinity is not indicated, the contacts of the main switch are
faulty.
B terminal – ACC terminal
Resistance B terminal – ST terminal Infinity
B terminal – G terminal

2) Main Switch Key at ON Position


1. Set the main switch ON position.
2. Measure the resistance with an ohmmeter across the B terminal
and the ACC terminal.
3. If 0 ohm is not indicated, the B – ACC contact of the main switch
are faulty.
Resistance B terminal – ACC terminal 0Ω

3) Main Switch Key at PREHEAT Position


1. Set and hold the main switch key at the PREHEAT position.
2. Measure the resistance with an ohmmeter across the B terminal
and the G terminal, and measure the resistance across the B
terminal and the ACC terminal.
3. If 0 ohm is not indicated, these contacts of the main switch are
faulty.
B terminal – G terminal
Resistance 0Ω
B terminal – ACC terminal

4) Main Switch Key at START Position


1. Set and hold the main switch key at the START position.
2. Measure the resistance with an ohmmeter across the B terminal
and the G terminal, across the B terminal and the ST terminal,
and across the B terminal and the ACC terminal.
3. If 0 ohm is not indicated, these contacts of the main switch are
faulty.
B terminal – G terminal
Resistance B terminal – ST terminal 0Ω
B terminal – ACC terminal

(1) G Terminal (3) ST Terminal


(2) ACC Terminal (4) B Terminal
9Y1210595ELS0013US0

6-S9

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

(3) Starter
Motor Test

CAUTION
• Secure the starter to prevent it from jumping up and down
while testing the motor.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable from the battery.
2. Disconnect the battery positive cable and the leads from the
starter.
3. Remove the starter from the engine.
4. Disconnect the connecting lead (2) from the starter C terminal
(1).
5. Connect a jumper lead from the connecting lead (2) to the
battery positive terminal post.
6. Connect a jumper lead momentarily between the starter motor
housing and the battery negative terminal post.
7. If the motor does not run, check the motor.
(1) C Terminal (2) Connecting Lead
9Y1210595ELS0014US0
Starter Magnet Switch Test (Pull-in, Holding Coils)
NOTE
• Prepare a 6 V battery for the test, and you must do each test
for 3 to 5 seconds.
1) Checking Pull-in Coil
1. Connect jumper lead from the battery's negative terminal post
to the C terminal.
2. The plunger should be attracted strongly when a jumper lead is
connected from the battery positive terminal to the S terminal.
2) Checking Holding Coil
1. Connect jumper leads from the battery's negative terminal post
to the body and the battery's positive terminal post to the S
terminal.
2. Push the plunger in by hand and release it. Then, the plunger
should remain being attracted.
9Y1210595ELS0047US0

6-S10

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

(4) Safety Switch


PTO Switch
1. Remove the battery.
2. Remove the fender.
3. Disconnect the connector from the PTO switch (1).
4. Measure the resistance with an ohmmeter between the
terminals.
5. If the PTO switch is damaged, replace it.
Resistance When plunger is pushed 0Ω
(between terminal a
and b) When plunger is released Infinity

Resistance When plunger is pushed 0Ω


(between terminal c
and d) When plunger is released Infinity

(1) PTO Switch a to d: Switch Terminal


(2) PTO Lever
9Y1210595ELS0016US0

Brake Switch
1. Remove the battery.
2. Remove the fender.
3. Disconnect the connector from the brake switch (1).
4. Measure the resistance with an ohmmeter between the
terminals.
5. If the brake switch is damaged, replace it.
Resistance When plunger is pushed 0Ω
(between terminal a
and b) When plunger is released Infinity

Resistance When plunger is pushed 0Ω


(between terminal c
and d) When plunger is released Infinity

(1) Brake Switch a to d: Switch Terminal


9Y1210595ELS0017US0

6-S11

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
Top Cover and Grass Container Open Switch [GR1600EU,
GR1600F]
1. Remove the battery.
2. Remove the open switches (1) (2).
3. Measure the resistance with an ohmmeter between the switch
terminals.
4. If the switches are damaged, replace them.
Resistance When plunger is pushed 0Ω
(between switch
terminals) When plunger is released Infinity

(1) Top cover Open Switch (2) Grass Container Open Switch
9Y1210595ELS0018US0

(5) Operator Presence Control (OPC) Switch


OPC Switch (Seat Switch)
1. Remove the battery.
2. Remove the OPC switch (1).
3. Measure the resistance with an ohmmeter between the OPC
switch terminals.
4. If the OPC switch is damaged, replace it.
Resistance When plunger is pushed 0Ω
(between switch
terminals) When plunger is released Infinity

(1) OPC Switch (Seat Switch)


9Y1210595ELS0019US0

6-S12

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

(6) Glow Plug


Lead Terminal Voltage
1. Disconnect the wiring lead (1) from the glow plug (2) after
turning the main switch off.
2. Turn the main switch key to the "PREHEAT" position, and
measure the voltage between the lead terminal and the chassis.
3. Turn the main switch key to the "START" position, and
measure the voltage with a voltmeter between the lead terminal
and the chassis.
4. If the voltage at either position differs from the battery voltage,
the wiring harness or main switch is faulty.
Main switch key at
Voltage Approx. battery voltage
"PREHEAT"
(Lead terminal –
Chassis Main switch key at
Approx. battery voltage
"START"

(1) Wiring Lead (Positive) (2) Glow Plug


9Y1210595ELS0020US0
Glow Plug Continuity
1. Disconnect the lead from the glow plugs.
2. Measure the resistance with an ohmmeter between the glow
plug terminal and the chassis.
3. If 0 ohm is indicated, the screw at the tip of the glow plug and
the housing are short-circuited.
4. If the factory specification is not indicated, the glow plug is
faulty.
Glow plug resistance Factory specification Approx. 0.9 Ω
9Y1210595ELS0021US0

6-S13

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

(7) Fuel Pump


Connector Voltage
1. Disconnect the 2P connector from the fuel pump.
2. Turn the main switch key to the "ON" position, and measure the
voltage with a voltmeter between the connector terminals.
3. If the voltage differs from the battery voltage, the wiring harness
or main switch is faulty.
Between connector
Voltage Approx. battery voltage
terminals
9Y1210595ELS0022US0

Fuel Pump
1. Disconnect the 2P connector from the fuel pump.
2. Check the continuity between the connector terminals with an
ohmmeter.
3. If it does not conduct, the fuel pump is faulty.
9Y1210595ELS0023US0

(8) Engine Stop Solenoid


Engine Stop Solenoid Test
1. Disconnect the 1P connector from the engine stop solenoid.
2. Remove the engine stop solenoid from the engine.
3. Connect the jumper leads from the battery positive terminal to
the 1P connector, and from the battery negative terminal to the
engine stop solenoid body.
4. If the solenoid plunger is not attracted, the engine stop solenoid
is faulty.
(1) Battery (12 V)
9Y1210595ELS0024US0

6-S14

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

(9) Engine Stop Timer Relay


Timer Relay Connector Voltage
1. Disconnect the connector from the timer relay after turning the
main switch off.
2. Measure the voltage with a voltmeter across the connector
terminal 4 and chassis.
3. Turn the main switch on, and measure the voltage across the
connector terminal 3 and chassis.
4. If these voltages differ from the battery voltage, the wiring
harness or main switch is faulty.
Connector
Approx. battery voltage
terminal 4 – chassis
Voltage
Connector
Approx. battery voltage
terminal 3 – chassis

(1) Timer Relay


9Y1210595ELS0025US0

Test of Timer Relay


1. Remove the timer relay from the machine.
2. Connect jumper leads across the battery positive terminal and
the timer relay terminal 3, and across the battery positive
terminal and the timer relay terminal 4.
3. Connect jumper leads across the battery negative terminal and
the timer relay terminal 2, and across the battery negative
terminal and the bulb terminal.
4. Connect jumper lead across the timer relay terminal 1 and the
bulb terminal.
5. The bulb lights up when disconnecting a jumper lead from the
terminal 3 arid goes off 6 to 13 seconds late, the timer relay is
proper.
(1) Timer Relay (3) Battery (12V)
(2) Load (Lamp)
9Y1210595ELS0026US0

6-S15

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

(10) Charging System


No-load Dynamo Output
1. Disconnect the lead wires from the dynamo.
2. Start the engine and operate the dynamo at the rated speed.
3. Measure the output voltage with a volt meter.
4. If the measurement is not within the specified values, replace
the dynamo.
No-load output Factory specification AC 20 V or more
9Y1210595ELS0029US0

Regulation Voltage

CAUTION
• To avoid personal injury, do not touch the rotating or hot
parts while the engine is running.
NOTE
• Before performing this checking, make sure that the
no-load dynamo output is proper.
• Complete the charging circuit with fully charged battery.
1. Rum the engine at the rated speed.
2. Keeping the coupler (2) of regulator being connected, measure
the voltage with a volt meter (5) across the terminal blue "a" and
terminal blue (c). (Refer to figure (A).)
3. If the measurement is not within the specified value, replace the
wire harness between the dynamo (4) and regulator (1).
4. If the measurement is within the specified value, measure the
voltage with a volt meter (6) across the terminal red "f" and
chassis. (Refer to figure (B).)
5. If the measurement is not within specified value, replace the
regulator (1).
Terminal blue "a" –
AC 20 V or more
Voltage Terminal blue "c"
Terminal red "f" – Chassis DC 14 to 15 V

(1) Regulator a: Terminal Blue


(2) Coupler b: Terminal Black
(3) Battery c: Terminal Blue
(4) Dynamo d: Terminal Green
(5) Volt Meter (AC) e: Terminal Yellow
(6) Volt Meter (DC) f: Terminal Red
9Y1210595ELS0030US0

6-S16

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

(11) Lighting System


Head Light Switch
1. Disconnect the wiring leads from head light switch and remove
it.
2. Measure the resistance with an ohmmeter across the head light
switch terminals in each position.
3. If the resistance differs from the factory specifications, the head
light switch is faulty.
Factory OFF Infinity
Resistance specifica-
tion ON 0Ω

(1) Head Light Switch


9Y1210595ELS0031US0

Engine Oil Pressure Lamp Harness


1. Disconnect the wiring harness from the engine oil pressure
switch (1) with the main switch OFF.
2. Turn the main switch ON and connect a jumper lead (2) from the
the chassis to the wiring harness.
3. If the engine oil pressure indicator lamp does not light, the wiring
harness is faulty.
(1) Engine Oil Pressure Switch (a) From Oil Pressure Lamp
(2) Jumper Lead
9Y1210595ELS0032US0

6-S17

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
Engine Oil Pressure Switch
1. Measure the resistance with an ohmmeter across the switch
terminal and the chassis.
2. If 0 ohm is not indicated in the normal state, the switch is faulty.
3. If infinity is not indicated at pressure over 50 kPa (0.5 kgf/cm2,
7 psi), the switch is faulty.
In normal state 0Ω
Resistance (Switch
terminal – Chassis) At pressure over approx.
Infinity
50 kPa (0.5 kgf/cm2, 7 psi)

(1) Engine Oil Pressure Switch


9Y1210595ELS0033US0

(12) Coolant Temperature Switch


Coolant Temperature Switch
1) Connector Voltage
1. Disconnect the 1P connector from the coolant temperature
switch (1).
2. Turn the main switch key to the "ON" position, and measure the
voltage with a voltmeter between the connector terminal and the
chassis.
3. If a certain voltage is not indicated, the wiring harness is faulty.
Voltage (Connector A certain voltage is
Factory specification
terminal – Chassis) indicated

2) Coolant Temperature Switch Continuity


1. Disconnect the 1P connector, and remove the thermo switch.
2. Using an ohmmeter, check for continuity between the switch
terminal and the chassis. The figure shows the operation
hysteresis.
3. If infinity is indicated at temperature over factory specifications,
the switch is faulty.
120 to 126 °C
Working temperature Factory specification
248 to 258 °F

(1) Coolant Temperature Switch (A) ON


(B) OFF
(C) 120 to 126 °C (248 to 258 °F)
(D) 116 °C (240 °F) or more
9Y1210595ELS0034US0

6-S18

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

(13) Grass Container Full Switch [GR1600EU, GR1600F]


Grass Container Full Switch Continuity
1. Remove the battery.
2. Dismount the grass container.
3. Remove the filter cover.
4. Disconnect the connector (1) from the grass container full
switch (2).
5. Measure the resistance with an ohmmeter between the grass
container full switch terminals.
6. If the grass container full switch is damaged, replace it.
When the diaphragm of
Resistance 0Ω
switch is pushed
(between switch
terminals) When the diaphragm of
Infinity
switch is released

(1) Connector (3) Flap


(2) Grass Container Full Switch
9Y1210595ELS0035US0

Buzzer
1. Remove the air intake net under the meter panel.
2. Disconnect the lead from buzzer (1).
3. Connect the jumper lead between the battery positive terminal
and terminal 1 of connector.
4. Connect the jumper lead between the battery negative terminal
and terminal 2 of connector.
5. If the buzzer does not whistle, replace it.
(1) Buzzer 1: Terminal 1
2: Terminal 2
9Y1210595ELS0036US0

6-S19

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

(14) Grass Container Full Switch Timer Relay [GR1600EU, GR1600F]


Removing Relay
1. Remove the grass container.
2. Remove the discharge duct.
3. Remove the screws (1).
4. Push the relay stay (2).
5. Remove the timer relay (3).
(1) Screw (3) Timer Relay
(2) Relay Stay
9Y1210595ELS0002US0

Timer Relay Connector Voltage


1. Measure the voltage with a voltmeter across the Red / White
terminal (2) and chassis.
2. Turn the main switch on, and measure the voltage across the
Yellow terminal (3) and chassis.
3. If these voltages differ from the battery voltage, the wiring
harness or main switch is faulty.
Red / White terminal (2) –
Approx. battery voltage
Chassis
Voltage
Yellow terminal (3) –
Approx. battery voltage
Chassis

(1) Timer Relay (4) Red Terminal


(2) Red / White Terminal (From Battery) (To Key Stop Solenoid)
(3) Yellow Terminal (5) Black Terminal (To Frame Earth)
(From Grass Container Fill Switch)
9Y1210595ELS0027US0
Test of Timer Relay
1. Remove the timer relay.
2. Connect the jumper leads across the battery terminal and the
Red / White terminal (1), and across the battery positive
terminal and the Yellow terminal (2).
3. Connect the jumper lead across the battery negative terminal
and the Black terminal (4), and across the battery negative
terminal and the Blue terminal.
4. Connect the jumper lead across the Red terminal (3) and the
bulb terminal.
5. The bulb lights up when disconnecting the jumper lead from the
Red / White terminal (1) 0.7 to 1.3 seconds, the timer relay is
proper.
(1) Red / White Terminal (From Battery) (4) Black Terminal (To Frame Earth)
(2) Yellow Terminal (5) Bulb (Load)
(From Grass Container Fill Switch) (6) Battery
(3) Red Terminal
(To Key Stop Solenoid)
9Y1210595ELS0028US0

6-S20

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

(15) Relays (Starter, Engine Overheat Horn, Grass Container Open, Grass
Container Full Switch, Buzzer)
Removing Starter Relay, Engine Overheat Horn Relay
1. Remove the starter relays (1), (2) from the steering support.
(1) Stater Relay (2) Engine Overheat Horn Relay
9Y1210595ELS0001US0

Removing Grass Container Open Relay, Grass Container Full


Switch Relay, Buzzer Relay [GR1600EU, GR1600F]
1. Remove the grass container.
2. Remove the discharge duct.
3. Remove the screws (1).
4. Push the relay stay (2).
5. Remove the relays (3), (4), (5).
(1) Screw (4) Grass Container Relay
(2) Relay Stay (5) Buzzer Relay
(3) Grass Container Full Switch Relay
9Y1210595ELS0004US0

Relay
1. Connect jumper leads across the battery positive terminal and
85 terminal (2), and across the battery negative terminal and 86
terminal (6).
2. Connect leads of an ohmmeter to 87a terminal (3) and 30
terminal (5).
3. Check continuity between 87a terminal (3) and 30 terminal (5).
4. If continuity is 0 ohms, the relay is proper.
(1) Relay (5) 30 Terminal
(2) 85 Terminal (6) 86 Terminal
(3) 87a Terminal (7) Battery (12V)
(4) 87 Terminal
9Y1210595ELS0005US0

6-S21

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

[2] DISASSEMBLING AND ASSEMBLING


(1) Starter
(1) Sleeve Bearing
(2) Bushing
(3) Starter Drive Housing
(4) Drive Lever
(5) Magnet Switch
(6) Yoke
(7) Connecting Lead
(8) Through Bolt
(9) Rear End Frame
(10) Bushing
(11) Brush
(12) Brush Holder
(13) Brush Spring
(14) Brush
(15) Washer
(16) Armature
(17) Overrunning Clutch

1. Disconnect the connecting lead (7).


2. Remove the magnetic switch (5).
3. Remove the rear end frame (9).
4. Remove the brush (11) from the brush holder (12).
5. Remove the brush holder (12).
6. Draw out the yoke (6) from the starter drive housing (3).
7. Draw out the armature (16) with the drive lever (4).
NOTE
• Do not cause damage to the brush and commutator.
(When reassembling)
• Apply grease to spline teeth of the armature, bushing, pinion gear of the overrunning clutch and armature shaft.
5.9 to 11 N·m
Tightening torque C terminal nut 0.60 to 1.2 kgf·m
4.4 to 8.6 lbf·ft

9Y1210595ELS0037US0

6-S22

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

(2) Dynamo
Stator
1. Remove the nut (3) and separate the stator comp. (4).
2. Remove the screws (1) and remove the stator (2).
40 to 44 N·m
Tightening torque Nut 4.0 to 4.5 kgf·m
29 to 32 lbf·ft

(1) Screw (3) Nut


(2) Stator (4) Stator Comp.
9Y1210595ELS0048US0

Rotor
1. Tap out the shaft (1) from the rotor (3).
(When reassembling)
• Be careful the direction of the collar (4), the flat side should face
to the pulley (2) side.
(1) Shaft (4) Collar
(2) Pulley (5) Bearings
(3) Rotor (6) Collar
9Y1210595ELS0049US0

6-S23

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

[3] SERVICING
(1) Starter
Overrunning Clutch
1. Inspect the pinion for wear or damage.
2. If there is any problem, replace the overrunning clutch
assembly.
3. Check that the pinion turns freely and smoothly in the
overrunning direction and does not slip in the cranking direction.
4. If the pinion slips or does not rotate in the both directions,
replace the overrunning clutch assembly.
9Y1210595ELS0050US0

Commutator and Mica


1. Check the contact face of the commutator for wear, and grind
the commutator with emery paper if it is slightly worn.
2. Measure the commutator O.D. with an outside micrometer at
several points.
3. If the minimum O.D. is less than the allowable limit, replace the
armature.
4. If the difference of the O.D.'s exceeds the allowable limit, correct
the commutator on a lathe to the factory specification.
5. Measure the mica undercut.
6. If the undercut is less than the allowable limit, correct it with a
saw blade and chamfer the segment edges.
28.0 mm
Factory specification
1.10 in.
Commutator O.D
27.0 mm
Allowable limit
1.06 in.

Less than
Factory specification 0.05 mm
Difference of O.D.'s 0.002 in.
0.4 mm
Allowable limit
0.02 in.

0.50 to 0.80 mm
Factory specification
0.020 to 0.031 in.
Mica undercut
0.20 mm
Allowable limit
0.0079 in.

(1) Segment (a) Correct


(2) Undercut (b) Incorrect
(3) Mica
9Y1210595ELS0041US0

Brush Wear
1. If the contact face of the brush is dirty or dusty, clean it with
emery paper.
2. Measure the brush length (A) with vernier calipers.
3. If the length is less than the allowable limit, replace the yoke
assembly and brush holder.
16.0 mm
Factory specification
0.630 in.
Brush length (A)
10.5 mm
Allowable limit
0.413 in.
9Y1210595ELS0042US0

6-S24

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
Brush Holder
1. Check the continuity across the brush holder and the holder
support with an ohmmeter.
2. If it conducts, replace the brush holder.
9Y1210595ELS0043US0

Armature Coil
1. Check the continuity across the commutator and armature coil
core with an ohmmeter.
2. If it conducts, replace the armature.
3. Check the continuity across the segments of the commutator
with an ohmmeter.
4. If it does not conduct, replace the armature.
9Y1210595ELS0044US0

Field Coil
1. Check the continuity across the lead (1) and brush (2) with an
ohmmeter.
2. If it does not conduct, replace the yoke assembly.
3. Check the continuity across the brush (2) and yoke (3) with an
ohmmeter.
4. If it conducts, replace the yoke assembly.
(1) Lead (3) Yoke
(2) Brush
9Y1210595ELS0045US0

6-S25

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

(2) Dynamo
Bearing
1. Check the bearing for smooth rotation.
2. If it does not rotate smoothly, replace it.
9Y1210595ELS0046US0

6-S26

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


7 MOWER

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


MECHANISM

CONTENTS

1. POWER TRANSMISSION.......................................................................................................... 7-M1


[1] RCK42GREU, RCK42GRF .................................................................................................. 7-M1
[2] RCK42-GR16 ....................................................................................................................... 7-M3
2. LIFTING MECHANISM ............................................................................................................... 7-M4

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM MOWER

1. POWER TRANSMISSION
[1] RCK42GREU, RCK42GRF

(1) Center Pulley (4) 18T Spiral Gear (7) Mower Belt (9) Blade Shaft
(2) Output Shaft (5) Input Shaft (8) Universal Joint (10) Blade
(3) 17T Spiral Gear (6) Outer Pulley

The power is transmitted from transmission case to blades as follows.


PTO Shaft → Universal Joint (8) → Input Shaft (5) → 18T Spiral Gear (4) → 17T Spiral Gear (3) → Output Shaft
(2) → Center Pulley (1) → Mower Belt (7) → Outer Pulley (6) → Blade Shaft (9) → Blade (10).
9Y1210595MOM0001US0

7-M1

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM MOWER

The mower belt moves in the arrow direction.


9Y1210595MOM0003US0

7-M2

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM MOWER

[2] RCK42-GR16

(1) Input Shaft (3) Output Shaft (5) Center Pulley (6) Gear Box Assembly
(2) 17T Spiral Gear (4) 18T Spiral Gear

The power is transmitted from transmission case to blades as follows.


PTO Shaft → Universal Joint → Input Shaft (1) → 17T Spiral Gear (2) → 18T Spiral Gear (4) → Output Shaft (3)
→ Center Pulley (5) → Mower Belt → Outer Pulley → Blade Shaft → Blade.
9Y1210595MOM0005US0

The mower belt moves in the arrow direction.


9Y1210595MOM0004US0

7-M3

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM MOWER

2. LIFTING MECHANISM

(1) Lift Link LH (4) Lift Link Shaft (7) Cutting Height Adjusting Dial (9) Lift Link RH
(2) Rear Link LH (5) Mower Lift Lever (8) Adjusting Cam (10) Rear Link RH
(3) Gas Spring (6) Lift Link

The rear link RH (10) and mower lift lever (5) are linked with lift link RH (9) and lift link (6). The rear link LH (2)
and mower lift lever (5) are linked with lift link LH (1), lift link shaft (4) and lift link (6).
As the mower lift lever (5) moves to "LIFT" position, the lift link (6) and lift link RH (9) are raised and the lift link
shaft (4) is rotated to raise the lift link LH (1). As a result, the rear link RH (10) and LH (2) are lifted. The gas spring
(3) connected with lift link shaft (4) assists lifting of mower.
The cutting height adjusting dial (7) adjusts cutting height of mower by rotating the adjusting cam. The position of
rear link RH (10) and LH (2) are adjusted by cutting height fine turning bolt on lift link (6) and lift link LH (1).
9Y1210595MOM0002US0

7-M4

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


SERVICING

CONTENTS

1. TROUBLESHOOTING.................................................................................................................7-S1
2. SERVICING SPECIFICATIONS ..................................................................................................7-S3
3. TIGHTENING TORQUES............................................................................................................7-S4
4. CHECKING, DISASSEMBLING AND SERVICING .....................................................................7-S5
[1] CHECKING AND ADJUSTING..............................................................................................7-S5
(1) RCK42GREU, RCK42GRF .............................................................................................7-S5
(2) RCK42-GR16 ..................................................................................................................7-S7
[2] PREPARATION (DISMOUNTING MOWER).......................................................................7-S10
(1) RCK42GREU, RCK42GRF ...........................................................................................7-S10
(2) RCK42-GR16 ................................................................................................................7-S11
[3] DISASSEMBLING AND ASSEMBLING ..............................................................................7-S14
(1) RCK42GREU, RCK42GRF ...........................................................................................7-S14
(2) RCK42-GR16 ................................................................................................................7-S17
(3) Mower Lift Linkage ........................................................................................................7-S20
[4] SERVICING .........................................................................................................................7-S21
(1) Gear Box [RCK42GREU, RCK42GRF] .........................................................................7-S21
(2) Gear Box [RCK42-GR16] ..............................................................................................7-S21

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM MOWER

1. TROUBLESHOOTING
Reference
Symptom Probable Cause Solution
Page
Blade Does Not Turn PTO system malfunctioning Check transmission –
Mower belt broken Replace mower belt 7-S14
Blade Speed Is Slow Mower belt loosen Replace mower belt 7-S14
or tension spring
Grass clogged Remove grass –
Cup washer flattened out or worn Remove cup washer 7-S14
Engine rpm too low Mow at full throttle, –
check and reset
engine rpm
Cutting Is Poor Mower blade worn or bent Sharpen or replace 7-S14
mower blade
Mower blade screw loosen Retighten mower 7-S14
blade screw
Cutting height improper Adjust cutting height 7-S6
Ground speed too fast Slow down –
Tire pressure uneven Add air to correct 7-S5
Anti-scalp rollers not adjusted correctly Adjust anti-scalp 7-S5
rollers
Mower Is Not Lifted Linkage system broken Replace linkage 7-S20
system
Discharge Chute Grass too wet Wait grass dry –
Plugged Grass too long Adjust cutting height –
Cutting too low Adjust cutting height –
Engine rpm too low Increase engine rpm –
Ground speed too fast Slow down –
Restricted airflow – –
Streaking of Uncut Ground speed too fast Slow down –
Grass Engine rpm too low Increase engine rpm –
Grass too long Adjust cutting height –
Blades dull or damaged Sharpen or replace G-46, G-48
the blades
Debris in mower deck Clean the debris –
Uneven Cut Mower deck not level Adjust the level 7-S6, 7-S8
Ground speed too fast Slow down –
Blades dull Sharpen the blades G-46, G-48
Blades worn Replace the blades G-46, G-48
Low tire inflation Inflate the tires 7-S5
Mower rollers not adjusted correctly Adjust the mower 7-S5
roller

7-S1

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM MOWER

Reference
Symptom Probable Cause Solution
Page
Blades Scalping Cutting height too low Increase the height –
Grass Blades speed too fast Decrease the speed –
Ridges in terrain – –
Rough or uneven terrain – –
Bent blade(s) Replace the blades G-46, G-48
Low tire inflation Inflate the tires 7-S5
Anti-scalp rollers not adjusted correctly Adjust the roller 7-S5
Belt Slipping Belt tension incorrect Replace the tension 7-S14
spring
Mower deck plugged Clean the mower –
deck
Debris in pulleys Clean the debris –
Worn belt Replace the belt 7-S14,
7-S17
Excessive Vibration Debris on mower deck or in pulleys Clean the debris –
Damaged mower belt Replace the mower 7-S14,
belt 7-S17
Damaged pulleys Replace the pulleys 7-S14,
7-S17
Pulleys out of alignment Replace the pulleys 7-S14,
7-S17
Blades out of balance Balance the blades G-46, G-48
Mower Loads Down Engine rpm too low Increase engine rpm –
Machine Ground speed too fast Slow down –
Debris wrapped around mower spindles. Clean the debris –
Grass Tips are Blades dull Sharpen the blades G-46, G-48
Jagged and Turn Blades worn Replace the blades G-46, G-48
Grayish Brown
Mower deck is not level Adjust the level 7-S6, 7-S8
9Y1210595MOS0017US0

7-S2

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM MOWER

2. SERVICING SPECIFICATIONS
RCK42GREU, RCK42GRF
Item Factory Specification Allowable Limit
Left Tip of Blade to Right Tip of Blade Difference Less than –
6.0 mm
0.24 in.
Front Tip of Blade to Rear Tip of Blade Difference Less than –
5.0 mm
0.20 in.
17T Spiral Gear to 18T Spiral Gear Backlash 0.13 to 0.25 mm 0.40 mm
0.052 to 0.0098 in. 0.016 in.

RCK42-GR16
Item Factory Specification Allowable Limit
Left Tip of Blade to Right Tip of Blade Difference Less than –
3.0 mm
0.12 in.
Front Tip of Blade to Rear Tip of Blade Difference Less than –
5.0 mm
0.20 in.
Y: Discharge Cover Height (D Point) to Difference Not more than –
X: Right Blade Tip Height 88 mm
3.5 in.
17T Spiral Gear to 18T Spiral Gear Backlash 0.13 to 0.25 mm 0.40 mm
0.052 to 0.0098 in. 0.016 in.
9Y1210595MOS0018US0

7-S3

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM MOWER

3. TIGHTENING TORQUES
Tightening torques of screws, bolts and nuts on the table below are especially specified.
(For general use screws, bolts and nuts: Refer to "5. TIGHTENING TORQUES" on page G-12.)
RCK42GREU, RCK42GRF
Item N·m kgf·m lbf·ft
Mower blade screw 98.1 to 117 10.0 to 12.0 72.4 to 86.7
Gear box mounting screw 78 to 90 7.9 to 9.2 58 to 66
Gear box bracket mounting screw and nut 48 to 55 4.9 to 5.7 36 to 41
Pulley mounting screw (gear box) 78 to 90 7.9 to 9.2 58 to 66
Pulley mounting nut (pulley holder) 103 to 117 10.5 to 12.0 76.0 to 86.7
Pulley holder mounting screw 48 to 55 4.9 to 5.7 36 to 41

RCK42-GR16
Item N·m kgf·m lbf·ft
Mower blade screw 98.1 to 117 10.0 to 12.0 72.4 to 86.7
Bolt M12 77.6 to 90.2 8.0 to 9.2 58 to 66
Bolt M10 and Nut M10 48.1 to 55.9 4.9 to 5.7 36 to 41
Pulley mounting screw (gear box) 78 to 90 7.9 to 9.2 58 to 66
Pulley mounting nut (pulley holder) 103 to 117 10.5 to 12.0 76.0 to 86.7
Pulley holder mounting screw 48 to 55 4.9 to 5.7 36 to 41
9Y1210595MOS0019US0

7-S4

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM MOWER

4. CHECKING, DISASSEMBLING AND SERVICING


[1] CHECKING AND ADJUSTING
(1) RCK42GREU, RCK42GRF
Adjusting Anti-scalp Rollers
IMPORTANT
• The flattest cut can be achieved by having the anti-scalp
rollers adjusted off the ground.
Check anti-scalp roller adjustments each time the mower
deck cutting height is changed.
It is recommended that all the anti-scalp rollers be kept off
the ground to minimize scuffing.
1. Check the machine wheel pressure.
Inflate wheels to the correct pressure. (See table below.)
Inflation Pressure
Front wheel 200 kPa, 2.0 kgf/cm2, 29 psi
Rear wheel 140 kPa, 1.4 kgf/cm2, 20 psi
2. Start the engine.
3. Raise up the mower deck to the transport position.
(Also the top end of the lift.)
4. Turn the cutting height control dial to adjust height.
5. Lower the mower deck.
 Front side anti-scalp roller
6. Adjust height "H" of the front side anti-scalp roller to one of
holes to approximately 6.0 to 13 mm (0.24 to 0.51 in.) between
rollers and ground. Adjust both side rollers to the same height.
7. Install the roller with attaching hardware.
 Rear side anti-scalp roller
8. Adjust height "H" of the rear side anti-scalp roller to one of holes
to approximately 19 mm (0.75 in.) between rollers and ground.
Adjust both side rollers to the same height.
9. Install the roller with attaching hardware.
(Reference)
• Set the position for a recommended ground clearance of 19 mm
(0.75 in.).
H: Height 19 mm (0.75 in.) F: Front
R: Rear
9Y1210595MOS0004US0

7-S5

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM MOWER
Adjusting Left and Right Cutting Height
1. Park the machine on level surface.
2. Wheel pressure must be correct.
3. Raise up the mower deck to the transport position.
(Also the top end.)
4. Turn the cutting height control dial (1) to the "3" position.
5. Place 51 mm (2 in.) height wood blocks under each side of the
mower deck.
Anti-scalp rollers must not rest on the wood block.
6. Lower the mower deck.
7. Adjust the left side equally.
8. Measure the heights of blade (L) and (R) from the ground
surface and calculate the difference.
9. If the difference between left tip and right tip of blade is not
within the factory specification, adjust the length of cutting
height fine tuning bolt (2).
Difference (L) - (R) Less than
between left tip and right Factory specification 6.0 mm
tip of blade 0.24 in.

(Reference)
• Length of cutting height fine tuning bolt "H":
16 to 20 mm (0.63 to 0.79 in.)
(1) Cutting Height Control Dial (L) Left Blade Measurement Position
(2) Cutting Height Fine Tuning Bolt (R) Right Blade Measurement
(3) Lock Nut Position
A: Blade Height
9Y1210595MOS0005US0

7-S6

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM MOWER
Adjusting Parallel Linkage
1. Park the machine on a level surface.
2. Wheel pressure must be correct.
3. Adjust the cutting height so that blade is level.
4. Position mower blade in the Front-to-Rear position.
5. Measure the height of blade "X" and "Y" from the ground
surface and calculate the difference.
6. If the difference between front tip and rear tip of blade is not
within the factory specification, adjust the length "L" of front link
with lock nut (1).
Difference "X" - "Y" Less than
between front tip and Factory specification 5.0 mm
rear tip of blade 0.20 in.

(Reference)
• "L": 26 to 28 mm (1.0 to 1.1 in.)
(1) Lock Nut X: Height of Blade Tip (Front)
Y: Height of Blade Tip (Rear)
9Y1210595MOS0006US0

(2) RCK42-GR16
Adjusting the Parallel Linkage

CAUTION
To avoid personal injury:
• Shut off the engine and remove the key.
• Set parking brake.
• Allow the blades to stop before making adjustments.
• Blades may be sharp, when you handle blades, wear heavy
gloves or wrap end of blade with a rag.
1. Park the machine on level surface.
2. Make sure the mower blades are level. Then tighten the lock
nuts securely.
Adjust (L) of front links with lock nut so that (B) - (A) is 0 to
5.0 mm (0 to 0.20 in.)
NOTE
• Make sure the rear blades is higher than the front blade;
otherwise beautiful finish cut can't be obtained.
(1) Lock Nut (A) Front
(B) Rear
F: Front
9Y1210595MOS0020US0

7-S7

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM MOWER
Adjusting the Mower Deck (Side to Side)

CAUTION
To avoid personal injury:
• Shut off the engine and remove the key.
• Set parking brake.
• Allow the blades to stop before making adjustments.
• Blades may be sharp, when you handle blades, wear heavy
gloves or wrap and of blade with a rag.
1. Park the machine on a level surface.
2. Tire inflation pressure must be correct.
See the table below.
Recommended Inflation
The sizes
Max. Pressure
200 kPa
Front 15 × 6.00-8, 4PR
(2.0 kgf/cm2, 29.0 psi)
140 kPa
Rear 20 × 10.00-8, 4PR
(1.4 kgf/cm2, 20.3 psi)
3. Raise the mower lift lever to the top position.
4. Turn the cutting height control dial to adjust height to the desired
height.
5. Lower the mower deck by pushing the mower lift lever forward.
6. Turn the left blade so that it is parallel to rear axle. Hold drive
belt and turn the right blade so that it is parallel to axle.
7. Measure from each outside blade tip (L) and (R) to the level
surface. The difference between measurements should be less
than 3 mm (0.12 in.).
8. Loosen the locknut at both sides of the machine.
Adjust the cutting height fine tuning bolts so that the difference
between measurements (L) and (R) is less than 3 mm (0.12 in.).
9. Lock the nuts.
10. Measure from the outside tip of the right blade to the level
surface (while the blade is parallel to the rear axle). This will be
measurement (X).
(1) Lift Link (H) Blade Tip Height
(2) Cutting Height Fine Tuning Bolt L: Left
(3) Lock Nut R: Right
(4) Mower Cover
(To be continued)

7-S8

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM MOWER
(Continued)
11. Measure from the level surface to the bottom of the discharge
cover at point "D" as shown in the figure below. This will be
measurement (Y).
12. The difference between measurement (Y) and (X) should be
88 mm (3.5 in.)
If not, adjust be loosing the bolt and moving the Plate Discharge
Stopper.

CAUTION
To avoid personal injury:
• Make sure (Y) - (X) is not more than 88 mm (3.5 in.)
(4) Mower Cover (6) Plate Discharge Stopper
(5) Bent Mark Line (7) Mower Deck Upper Surface
9Y1210595MOS0021US0

Adjusting the Mower Lift Stopper


The mower lift stoppers are designed to keep the balance of the
mower deck, when lifting the mower to the highest position. Make
sure that the stopper is in contact with the underside of the frame.
To adjust:
1. Lift the mower to the highest position.
2. Loosen the lock nut and adjust the stopper on left side so that
the bolt head is in contact with the underside of the frame.
3. Lower the mower deck.
4. Turn the stopper counterclockwise a half turn, and then secure
the lock nut.
(1) Mower Lift Stopper (2) Lock Nut
9Y1210595MOS0022US0

7-S9

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM MOWER

[2] PREPARATION (DISMOUNTING MOWER)


(1) RCK42GREU, RCK42GRF
CAUTION
• To avoid personal injury:
Shut off the engine and remove the key before dismounting the mower.
9Y1210595MOS0028US0
Cutting Height Adjusting Dial
1. Park the machine on level ground, and stop the engine.
2. Set the cutting height adjusting dial (1) to "1" position.
3. Set the front anti-scalp rollers at the top position.
4. Lower the mower lift lever (2) and lock in the lower position.
(1) Cutting Height Adjusting Dial (2) Mower Link Lever
9Y1210595MOS0007US0

Front Link
1. Pull the lever fulcrum fixing pin (2) and turn it counterclockwise
to lock.
2. Push down the link fixing lever (1).
3. Remove the front link (3) from the mower deck.
(When reassembling)
• When you attach the front link, make sure the length of the front
link.
(1) Link Fixing Lever (3) Front Link
(2) Lever Fulcrum Fixing Pin
9Y1210595MOS0008US0
Rear Link and Universal Joint
1. Disconnect the rotate plate rod (1).
2. Disconnect the rear link (2) from the mower deck, pulling the
L-pins (3).
3. Disconnect the universal joint (4) from the PTO shaft.
4. Raise the mower lift lever and lock in the raised position.
(When reassembling)
• Apply grease to the spline of PTO shaft.
• Slide the universal joint back and front to make sure the
universal joint is locked securely.
• When attach the rear links, make sure the length of the rear
links.
(1) Rotate Plate Rod (3) L-pin
(2) Rear Link (4) Universal Joint
9Y1210595MOS0009US0

7-S10

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM MOWER
Dismounting Mower
1. Turn the front wheel to the right.
2. Pull out the mower deck to the left.
9Y1210595MOS0010US0

(2) RCK42-GR16
Cutting Height Adjusting Dial
1. Park the machine on level ground, and stop the engine.
2. Set the cutting height adjusting dial (1) to "1" position.
3. Set the front anti-scalp rollers at the top position.
4. Lower the mower lift lever (2) and lock in the lower position.
(1) Cutting Height Adjusting Dial (2) Mower Link Lever
9Y1210595MOS0007US0

Front Link
1. Pull the lever fulcrum fixing pin (2) and turn it counterclockwise
to lock.
2. Push down the link fixing lever (1).
3. Remove the front link (3) from the mower deck.
(When reassembling)
• When you attach the front link, make sure the length of the front
link.
(1) Link Fixing Lever (3) Front Link
(2) Lever Fulcrum Fixing Pin
9Y1210595MOS0008US0

7-S11

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM MOWER
Disconnecting the Rear Link
1. Release the L-pins (1).
2. Disconnecting the rear link (2) from the mower bracket (3).
(1) L-pin A: "UNLOCK"
(2) Rear link B: "RELEASE"
(3) Mower bracket
9Y1210595MOS0023US0

7-S12

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM MOWER
Removing the Universal Joint
1. Remove the bolt (1) and stay (3) from the frame.
2. Shorten the universal joint cover (2) from the coupler of the
universal joint.
3. Pull back the coupler (5) of the universal joint.
4. Disconnect the universal joint (4) into the PTO shaft until the
coupler locks.
(1) Bolt (4) Universal Joint
(2) Universal Joint Cover (5) Coupler
(3) Stay
9Y1210595MOS0024US0

7-S13

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM MOWER

[3] DISASSEMBLING AND ASSEMBLING


(1) RCK42GREU, RCK42GRF
Mower Blades (Left Blade and Right Blades)
1. Turn over the mower.
2. Remove the mower blade screw (1), and remove the shim (2),
two cup washers (3), mower blade (4) and dust cover (6).
NOTE
• To remove the blade securely, wedge a block of wood
between one blade and the mower deck in such position
that it will hold the blade safely while loosing or tightening
the blade screw.
(When reassembling)
• Be sure to assemble the two cup washers between the mower
blade and the mower blade screw.
IMPORTANT
• Make sure the cup washer is not flattened out or worn,
causing blade to slip easily.
Replace two cup washers if either is damaged.
98.1 to 117 N·m
Tightening torque Mower blade screw 10.0 to 12.0 kgf·m
72.4 to 86.7 lbf·ft

(1) Mower Blade Screw (5) Spindle Holder


(2) Shim (6) Dust Cover
(3) Cap Washer
(4) Mower Blade A: Loosen
9Y1210595MOS0031US0
Gear Box and Mower Belt
1. Remove the left and right belt covers from the mower deck.
2. Disconnect the universal joint (4) from the gear box (1).
3. Clean around the gear box (1).
4. Remove the mower belt (2) from the tension pulley (3).
5. Remove the gear box mounting screws (5) and gear box
bracket mounting screws and nuts (6).
6. Remove the gear box (1) and mower belt (2).
78 to 90 N·m
Gear box mounting screw 7.9 to 9.2 kgf·m
58 to 66 lbf·ft
Tightening torque
48 to 55 N·m
Gear box bracket mounting
4.9 to 5.7 kgf·m
screw and nut
36 to 41 lbf·ft

(1) Gear Box (5) Gear Box Mounting Screw


(2) Mower Belt (6) Gear Box Bracket Mounting Screw
(3) Tension Pulley and Nut
(4) Universal Joint
9Y1210595MOS0012US0

7-S14

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM MOWER
Disassembling Gear Box
1. Remove the drain plug (10), and drain the gear box oil.
2. Remove the pulley mounting screw (1), and remove the pulley
(3).
3. Remove the case cover (15).
4. Remove the shim (14) and 18T spiral gear (12) with ball bearing
(13).
5. Remove the 17T spiral gear (16) and shim (17).
6. Remove the oil seal (22) and internal snap ring (21).
7. Draw out the input shaft (19) with two ball bearing (18), (20).
8. Remove the oil seal (5) and internal snap ring (6).
9. Draw out the output shaft (2) with the ball bearing (7).
10. Remove two external snap rings (4), (8) on the output shaft (2)
to remove the ball bearing (7).
(When reassembling)
• Replace the oil seals (5), (22) with new ones.
• Apply grease to the splines of input shaft and of output shaft.
IMPORTANT
• Use the specified gear box oil.
• Refer to "4. LUBRICANTS, FUEL AND COOLANT" on page
G-9.
0.33 L
Gear box oil capacity 0.35 U.S.qts
0.29 Imp.qts

78 to 90 N·m
Tightening torque Pulley mounting screw 7.9 to 9.2 kgf·m
58 to 66 lbf·ft

(1) Pulley Mounting Screw (12) 18T Spiral Gear


(2) Output Shaft (13) Ball Bearing
(3) Pulley (14) Shim
(4) External Snap Ring (15) Case Cover
(5) Oil Seal (16) 17T Spiral Gear
(6) Internal Snap Ring (17) Shim
(7) Ball Bearing (18) Ball Bearing
(8) External Snap Ring (19) Input Shaft
(9) Case (20) Ball Bearing
(10) Drain Plug (21) Internal Snap Ring
(11) O-ring (22) Oil Seal
9Y1210595MOS0032US0

7-S15

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM MOWER
Disassembling Pulley Holder
1. Remove the grease fitting (12).
2. Remove the pulley mounting nut (11), and remove the pulley
(10).
3. Tap out the blade shaft (1).
4. Remove the pulley holder (6) from the mower deck.
5. Remove the oil seal (2), (9).
6. Remove the ball bearings (3), (7) and collar (4).
103 to 117 N·m
Pulley mounting nut 10.5 to 12.0 kgf·m
76.0 to 86.7 lbf·ft
Tightening torque
48 to 55 N·m
Pulley holder mounting
4.9 to 5.7 kgf·m
screw
36 to 41 lbf·ft

(1) Blade Shaft (7) Ball Bearing


(2) Oil Seal (8) Pulley Holder Mounting Nut
(3) Ball Bearing (9) Oil Seal
(4) Collar (10) Pulley
(5) Pulley Holder Mounting Screw (11) Pulley Mounting Nut
(6) Pulley Holder (12) Grease Fitting
9Y1210595MOS0033US0

7-S16

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM MOWER

(2) RCK42-GR16
Removing Mower Blades
Before you remove the blade, wipe grass and mud off the top
and inside of the mower. Especially clean up the inside of the belt
cover, because otherwise the belt life will decrease.
1. Remove the mower deck from the machine and turn it over to
expose the blades.
2. Wedge a block (1) of wood between the blade (2), (3) and
mower housing as illustrated.
3. The bolt (5) for black blade has right hand threads, turn
counterclockwise to loosen.
The bolt (6) for red blade has left hand threads, turn clockwise
to loosen.
NOTE
• Use the proper size box or socket wrench to tighten or
loosen the blade mounting bolt.
• Black blade (2) to be assembled at discharge deflector
(Black color) side.
Red blade (3) to be assembled at mower deck wall (Red
color) side.
(When reassembling)
• To attach blades, be sure to install the two cup washers and two
plain washers between the blade and bolt head.
• Make sure that the cup washer is not flattened out or worn; this
may cause blade to slip excessively.
Replace the two cup washers if either is damaged.
IMPORTANT
• Tighten the 2 blade bolts (5), (6) to 98 to 117.6 N·m (10 to
12 kgf·m, 73 to 86 lbf·ft) of torque.
(1) Block (8) 2-Cup Washer
(2) Blade (Black) (9) Plain Washer
(3) Blade (Red) (10) Spindle Guard
(4) Discharge Deflector
(5) Bolt (Right Hand Thread) (A) "LOOSEN"
(6) Bolt (Left Hand Thread) (L) 30 mm (1.2 in.)
(7) Spindle Holder
9Y1210595MOS0025US0
Mower Belt Replacement
1. Remove the all shields from the mower deck.
2. Clean around the pulleys to remove the belt (1) from the pulleys.
Slip the belt over the top of the pulley.
3. Remove the right bracket (4) which mounts the gear box (2) to
the mower deck.
(When reassembling)
Tighten each bolt and nut with following torque.
Bolt M12:
77.6 to 90.2 N·m (8.0 to 9.2 kgf·m, 58 to 66 lbf·ft)
Bolt M10 and Nut M10:
48.1 to 55.9 N·m (4.9 to 5.7 kgf·m, 36 to 41 lbf·ft)
(1) Belt (4) Right Bracket
(2) Gear Box (5) Bolt M10
(3) Bolt M12
9Y1210595MOS0026US0

7-S17

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM MOWER
Disassembling Gear Box

(1) Pulley Mounting Screw


(2) Washer
(3) Pulley
(4) Output Shaft
(5) Oil Seal
(6) Internal Snap Ring
(7) Shim
(8) Ball Bearing
(9) Shim
(10) Internal Snap Ring
(11) Drain Plug
(12) Gear Case
(13) 17T Spiral Gear
(14) 18T Spiral Gear
(15) O-ring
(16) Ball Bearing
(17) Case Cover
(18) Shim
(19) Ball Bearing
(20) Input Shaft
(21) Ball Bearing
(22) Shim
(23) Internal Snap Ring
(24) Oil Seal

1. Remove the drain plug (11), and drain the gear box oil.
2. Remove the pulley mounting screw (1), and remove the pulley (3).
3. Remove the case cover (17).
4. Remove the oil seal (24) and internal snap ring (23).
5. Draw out the input shaft (20) with two ball bearing (19), (21).
6. Remove the oil seal (5) and internal snap ring (6).
7. Draw out the output shaft (4) with the ball bearing (8).
8. Remove the two internal snap rings (6), (10) on the output shaft (4) to remove the ball bearing (8).
9. Remove the 17T spiral gear (14) and 18T spiral gear (13).
(When reassembling)
• Replace the oil seals (5), (24) with new ones.
• Apply grease to the splines of input shaft and of output shaft.
IMPORTANT
• Use the specified gear box oil.
• Refer to "4. LUBRICANTS, FUEL AND COOLANT" on page G-9.
0.35 L
Gear box oil Capacity 0.37 U.S.qts
0.31 lmp.qts

78 to 90 N·m
Tightening torque Pulley mounting screw 7.9 to 9.2 kgf·m
58 to 66 lbf·ft

9Y1210595MOS0029US0

7-S18

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM MOWER
Disassembling Pulley Holder

(1) Blade Shaft


(2) Oil Seal
(3) Ball Bearing
(4) Collar
(5) Pulley Holder Mounting
Screw
(6) Pulley Holder
(7) Ball Bearing
(8) Oil Seal
(9) Pulley Plate
(10) Pulley Holder Mounting Nut
(11) Pulley
(12) Pulley Mounting Nut

1. Remove the pulley mounting nut (12), and remove the pulley (11).
2. Tap out the blade shaft (1).
3. Remove the pulley holder (6) from the mower deck.
4. Remove the oil seal (2), (8).
5. Remove the ball bearings (3), (7) and collar (4).
103 to 117 N·m
Pulley holder mounting nut 10.5 to 12.0 kgf·m
76.0 to 87.0 lbf·ft
Tightening torque
48 to 55 N·m
Pulley holder mounting
4.9 to 5.7 kgf·m
screw
36 to 41 lbf·ft

9Y1210595MOS0030US0

7-S19

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM MOWER

(3) Mower Lift Linkage


(1) Screw
(2) Gas Spring Mounting Nut
(3) Lock Nut
(4) Rear Link LH
(5) Clevis Pin
(6) Lift Link LH
(7) Rue Ring
(8) Rue Ring
(9) Gas Spring Mounting Nut
(10) Gas Spring
(11) Rue Ring
(12) Rue Ring
(13) Clevis Pin
(14) Lift Link RH
(15) Lift Link
(16) Cotter Pin
(17) Rear Link RH
(18) Lock Nut
(19) Screw

1. Dismount the mower. (Refer to "[2] PREPARATION (DISMOUNTING MOWER)" on page 7-S10.)
2. Remove the fender. (Refer to "[2] PREPARATION" on page 2-S10.)
3. Set the mower lift lever to "LIFT" position.
4. Remove the gas spring mounting nuts (2), (9), and then remove the gas spring (10).
5. Remove the screws (1), (19) and lock nuts (2), (18), and pull out the rue rings (7), (11).
6. Remove the rear link LH (4) and RH (17).
7. Pull out the rue rings (7), (12) and remove the clevis pins (5), (13).
8. Remove the lift link LH (6) and RH (14).
9. Pull out the cotter pin (16), and remove the lift link (15) from the mower lift lever.
9Y1210595MOS0034US0

7-S20

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


GR1600EU, WSM MOWER

[4] SERVICING
(1) Gear Box [RCK42GREU, RCK42GRF]
Backlash between 17T Spiral Gear and 18 Spiral Gear
1. Remove the 18T spiral gear (6) from gear box.
2. Stick the strip of plastigauge the 18T spiral gear (6) with grease.
3. Reassemble the gear box.
4. Turn the input shaft (1).
5. Remove the plastigauge, and measure the thickness of
plastigauge. (Backlash equal thickness of plastigauge.)
6. If the backlash exceeds the allowable limit, adjust with shims
(2), (5).
0.13 to 0.25 mm
Backlash between 17T Factory specification
0.0052 to 0.0098 in.
spiral gear and 18T
spiral gear 0.40 mm
Allowable limit
0.016 in.

(Reference)
• Thickness of adjusting shims
– for 17T spiral gear (2):
0.20 mm (0.0079 in.)
0.30 mm (0.012 in.)
– for 18T spiral gear (5):
0.20 mm (0.0079 in.)
0.30 mm (0.012 in.)
(1) Input Shaft (4) Output Shaft
(2) Shim (for 17T Spiral Gear) (5) Shim (for 18T Spiral Gear)
(3) 17T Spiral Gear (6) 18T Spiral Gear
9Y1210595MOS0035US0

(2) Gear Box [RCK42-GR16]


Backlash between 17T Spiral Gear and 18 Spiral Gear
1. Remove the bevel gear case cover (5).
2. Put a strip of plastigauge on the 18T spiral gear (6) with grease.
3. Attach the bevel gear case cover (5).
4. Turn the input shaft (1).
5. Remove the plastigauge, and measure the plastigauge. (The
backlash is equal to the thickness of plastigauge.)
6. If the backlash exceeds the allowable limit, adjust with shims
(2), (7).
(Reference)
• Thickness of adjusting shims
– for 17T spiral gear (2):
0.20 mm (0.0079 in.)
0.30 mm (0.012 in.)
– for 18T spiral gear (7):
0.20 mm (0.0079 in.)
0.30 mm (0.012 in.)
(1) Input Shaft (5) Bevel Gear Case Cover
(2) Shim (for 17T Spiral Gear) (6) 18T Spiral Gear
(3) 17T Spiral Gear (7) Shim (for 18T Spiral Gear)
(4) Output Shaft
9Y1210595MOS0027US0

7-S21

KiSC issued 11, 2013 A


EDITOR :
KUBOTA FARM & INDUSTRIAL MACHINERY SERVICE, LTD.
64, ISHIZU-KITAMACHI, SAKAI-KU, SAKAI-CITY, OSAKA, 590-0823, JAPAN
PHONE : (81)72-241-1129
FAX : (81)72-245-2484
E-mail : [email protected]

Printed in Japan 2013. 11, S, EI, EI, engusa Code No.9Y111-05953


KUBOTA Corporation 2011. 06, S, EI, EI, engusa

You might also like